]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
* doc/tm.texi.in (Cond. Exec. Macros): Rename node from this ...
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
c58b209a 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
9b7e6950 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
66647d44 3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
feca2ed3
JW
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
672a6f42 8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
feca2ed3
JW
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
672a6f42
NB
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
648c546a 22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
672a6f42
NB
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
feca2ed3
JW
27
28@menu
648c546a 29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
feca2ed3 30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
630d3d5a 31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
414c4dc4 32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
feca2ed3
JW
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
f38840db 37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
feca2ed3 38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
6ccde948 39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
feca2ed3
JW
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
aacd3885 43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
feca2ed3
JW
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
c237e94a 46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
feca2ed3 47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
6ccde948 48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
feca2ed3
JW
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
b216cd4a 51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
9f09b1f2 52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
91d231cb 53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
feb60f03 54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
d604bca3 55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7bb1ad93 56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
4185ae53 57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
09e881c9 58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
feca2ed3
JW
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
672a6f42 62@node Target Structure
648c546a 63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
672a6f42
NB
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
f6897b10
SS
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
672a6f42
NB
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
91d231cb
JM
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
672a6f42 83
f6897b10 84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
672a6f42
NB
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
648c546a 89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
672a6f42
NB
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
648c546a 92@code{targetm} structure.
672a6f42 93
feca2ed3
JW
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
a2c4f8e0 102@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
db36994b
RS
103A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
104initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
105
3bd6d4c4
AO
106The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
107default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
108choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
109applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
110options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
111using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
db36994b
RS
112
113This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
114options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
115that the other specs are easier to write.
116
117Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 118@end defmac
db36994b 119
a2c4f8e0 120@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7816bea0
DJ
121A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
122@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
123for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
124outermost pair of surrounding braces.
125
126The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
127the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
128to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
129@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
130everywhere it occurs.
131
132The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
133default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
134the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
135
136Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 137@end defmac
7816bea0 138
a2c4f8e0 139@defmac CPP_SPEC
a3a15b4d 140A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
161d7b59
JM
141pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
142give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
feca2ed3
JW
143
144Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 145@end defmac
feca2ed3 146
a2c4f8e0 147@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
a9374841 148This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
161d7b59 149than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
a9374841 150@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
a2c4f8e0 151@end defmac
a9374841 152
a2c4f8e0 153@defmac CC1_SPEC
a3a15b4d 154A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
66519c70
JL
155pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
156front ends.
a3a15b4d 157It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
630d3d5a 158for GCC to pass to front ends.
feca2ed3
JW
159
160Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 161@end defmac
feca2ed3 162
a2c4f8e0 163@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
a3a15b4d 164A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 165pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 166give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
feca2ed3
JW
167
168Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
1d96e5b4
FF
169Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
170@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
161d7b59 171CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 172@end defmac
feca2ed3 173
a2c4f8e0 174@defmac ASM_SPEC
a3a15b4d 175A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 176pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
a3a15b4d 177you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
feca2ed3
JW
178See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
179
180Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 181@end defmac
feca2ed3 182
a2c4f8e0 183@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
a3a15b4d 184A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
feca2ed3
JW
185run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
186Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
187an example of this.
188
189Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 190@end defmac
feca2ed3 191
a2c4f8e0 192@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
4977bab6
ZW
193Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
194an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
195read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
196output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
197@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
198
199If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
200standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
201cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
202see @file{mips.h} for instance.
a2c4f8e0 203@end defmac
4977bab6 204
a2c4f8e0 205@defmac LINK_SPEC
a3a15b4d 206A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 207pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 208give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
feca2ed3
JW
209
210Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 211@end defmac
feca2ed3 212
a2c4f8e0 213@defmac LIB_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
214Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
215between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
216command given to the linker.
217
218If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
219loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 220@end defmac
feca2ed3 221
a2c4f8e0 222@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
a3a15b4d 223Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
feca2ed3
JW
224how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
225linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
226the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
227
a3a15b4d 228If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
630d3d5a 229passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
a2c4f8e0 230@end defmac
feca2ed3 231
328163dc
MA
232@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
233By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
234@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
235instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
4ec7afd7
KH
236depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
237@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
328163dc
MA
238targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
239@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
240driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
241line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
242@end defmac
243
743eeb5a
AM
244@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
245A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
246mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
247generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
248static exception handler library, when linking without any of
249@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
250@end defmac
251
252@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
253If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
254When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
255the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
256@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
257@end defmac
258
a2c4f8e0 259@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
260Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
261difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
262the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
263
264If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
265standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 266@end defmac
feca2ed3 267
a2c4f8e0 268@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
269Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
270difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
271the very end of the command given to the linker.
272
273Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 274@end defmac
feca2ed3 275
a2c4f8e0 276@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
008355a6
AO
277GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
278However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
279models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
280@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
281blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
282default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
283@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
a2c4f8e0 284@end defmac
008355a6 285
a2c4f8e0 286@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
287Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
288configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
289et al, within sysroot+suffix.
a2c4f8e0 290@end defmac
e7f13528 291
a2c4f8e0 292@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
293Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
294GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
f4314bb6 295updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
e7f13528 296usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
a2c4f8e0 297@end defmac
e7f13528 298
a2c4f8e0 299@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
feca2ed3
JW
300Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
301@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
302@code{CC1_SPEC}.
303
304The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
305containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
306string constant that provides the specification.
307
308Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
309
310@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
630d3d5a 311related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
feca2ed3
JW
312to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
313these definitions.
314
315For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
316define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
317used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
318used.
319
320The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
321
3ab51846 322@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
323#define EXTRA_SPECS \
324 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
325
326#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
3ab51846 327@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
328
329The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
330@smallexample
331#undef CPP_SPEC
332#define CPP_SPEC \
333"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
50d440bc
NC
334%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
335%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
feca2ed3
JW
336%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
337
338#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
339#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
340@end smallexample
341
342while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
343@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
344
345@smallexample
346#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
348@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 349@end defmac
feca2ed3 350
a2c4f8e0 351@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
feca2ed3
JW
352Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
353@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
630d3d5a 354the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
a2c4f8e0 355@end defmac
feca2ed3 356
a2c4f8e0 357@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
bbd7687d
DM
358The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
359By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
a2c4f8e0 360@end defmac
bbd7687d 361
a2c4f8e0 362@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9ec36da5
JL
363A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
364linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
365change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
366define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
367line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
bbd7687d
DM
368the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
369@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
a2c4f8e0 370@end defmac
9ec36da5 371
a2c4f8e0 372@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
2cc07db4 373A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
5897739e
JO
374directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
375removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
a2c4f8e0 376@end defmac
5897739e 377
a2c4f8e0 378@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3
JW
379Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
380string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
381target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
382@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
383
384Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
385the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
386@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
387@xref{Target Fragment}.
a2c4f8e0 388@end defmac
feca2ed3 389
a2c4f8e0 390@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
05739753 391Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
630d3d5a 392a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
feca2ed3 393indicates an absolute file name.
a2c4f8e0 394@end defmac
feca2ed3 395
a2c4f8e0 396@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
397If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
398@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
1401cf37 399when the compiler is built as a cross
5505263f
JL
400compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
401to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
a2c4f8e0 402@end defmac
feca2ed3 403
a2c4f8e0 404@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3 405Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
0d037580 406standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
feca2ed3 407try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
0d037580
DJ
408@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
409is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 410@end defmac
feca2ed3 411
656c7a3a
AL
412@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
413Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
415when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
417is built as a cross compiler.
418@end defmac
419
420@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
423default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
425is built as a cross compiler.
426@end defmac
427
a2c4f8e0 428@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
429If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
430standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
1401cf37 431compiler is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 432@end defmac
feca2ed3 433
a2c4f8e0 434@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
feca2ed3 435If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
1401cf37
MLI
436standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
437cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 438@end defmac
feca2ed3 439
a2c4f8e0 440@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
e9a25f70 441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
feca2ed3
JW
442variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
443loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
444initialize the necessary environment variables.
a2c4f8e0 445@end defmac
feca2ed3 446
a2c4f8e0 447@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
448Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
449standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
450try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
451comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
452
c237e94a
ZW
453Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
454replacement.
a2c4f8e0 455@end defmac
feca2ed3 456
a2c4f8e0 457@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
458Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
459system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
460directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
461@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
462
463Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
464specified.
a2c4f8e0 465@end defmac
feca2ed3 466
a2c4f8e0 467@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for header files.
471
a2c4f8e0 472Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
feca2ed3 473@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
a2c4f8e0 474@end defmac
feca2ed3 475
a2c4f8e0 476@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
e9a25f70
JL
477The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
478See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
479If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
a2c4f8e0 480@end defmac
e9a25f70 481
a2c4f8e0 482@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3 483Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
e9a25f70
JL
484for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
485usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
feca2ed3
JW
486@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
487@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
488and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
161d7b59 489and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
feca2ed3
JW
490@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
491
492The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
e9a25f70 493Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
9f6dc500
HPN
494string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
495for C++-only directories,
e9a25f70
JL
496and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
497wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
498the array with a null element.
499
500The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
4bd0bee9 501if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
9f6dc500 502or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
e9a25f70
JL
503operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
504
e9a25f70 505For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
feca2ed3 506
3ab51846 507@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
508#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
509@{ \
e9a25f70
JL
510 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
511 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
feca2ed3 515@}
3ab51846 516@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 517@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
518
519Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
520
521@enumerate
522@item
630d3d5a 523Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
524
525@item
fe037b8a
CD
526The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
527is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
528@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
feca2ed3
JW
529
530@item
531The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
532
533@item
fe037b8a
CD
534The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
535in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
feca2ed3
JW
536
537@item
fe037b8a 538The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
539
540@item
fe037b8a
CD
541The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
542
543@item
544The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
545compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
546@end enumerate
547
548Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
549
550@enumerate
551@item
630d3d5a 552Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
553
554@item
fe037b8a
CD
555The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
556value based on the installed toolchain location.
feca2ed3
JW
557
558@item
559The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
512b62fb 560(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
feca2ed3
JW
561
562@item
fe037b8a
CD
563The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
564in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
565
566@item
fe037b8a
CD
567The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
568
569@item
570The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
571compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
572
573@item
fe037b8a
CD
574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
576
577@item
fe037b8a
CD
578The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
579native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
580
581@item
fe037b8a
CD
582The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
583If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
584the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
feca2ed3
JW
585
586@item
fe037b8a
CD
587The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
588compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
589@file{/lib/}.
590
591@item
fe037b8a
CD
592The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
593compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
594@file{/usr/lib/}.
595@end enumerate
596
597@node Run-time Target
598@section Run-time Target Specification
599@cindex run-time target specification
600@cindex predefined macros
601@cindex target specifications
602
603@c prevent bad page break with this line
604Here are run-time target specifications.
605
a2c4f8e0 606@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22 607This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
44082375 608built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
1f95326c 609the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
cb60f38d 610@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
12a41c22
NB
611calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
612finished command line option processing your code can use those
613results freely.
3df89291
NB
614
615@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
616command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
d90a95fb 617the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
3df89291
NB
618accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
619
d90a95fb 620@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
3df89291 621object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
d90a95fb 622@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
3df89291
NB
623defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
624with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
625only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
626example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
627and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
628@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
629defines only @code{_ABI64}.
630
e0322d5c
NB
631You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
632@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
633or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
634assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
635macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
ce3649d2 636to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
c219e1da
JDA
637variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
638@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
639preprocessing.
a2c4f8e0 640@end defmac
e0322d5c 641
a2c4f8e0 642@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22
NB
643Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644and is used for the target operating system instead.
a2c4f8e0 645@end defmac
12a41c22 646
a2c4f8e0 647@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
4e2e315f
NB
648Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
649and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
650macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
651it yourself.
a2c4f8e0 652@end defmac
4e2e315f 653
a2c4f8e0 654@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
75685792
RS
655This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
656any target-specific headers.
a2c4f8e0 657@end deftypevar
feca2ed3 658
9e3be889 659@deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
75685792
RS
660This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
661Its default setting is 0.
9e3be889 662@end deftypevr
75685792 663
bacf5b96
RS
664@cindex optional hardware or system features
665@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
666
75685792
RS
667@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
668This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
669target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
670(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
671processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
672definition does nothing but return true.
673
674@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
675associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
676the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
677underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
678no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
679(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
680argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
681option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
682@end deftypefn
683
1f1d5130
MS
684@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
685This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
686target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
687definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
688option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
7a241624
JR
689valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
690default definition does nothing but return false.
1f1d5130
MS
691
692In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
693options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
694only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
695should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
696@end deftypefn
697
91ebb981
IS
698@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
699Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
700@end deftypefn
701
702@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
703If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
704@end deftypefn
705
706@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
707If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
26705988
IS
708@end deftypefn
709
a2c4f8e0 710@defmac TARGET_VERSION
feca2ed3
JW
711This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
712describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
713description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
714
715@smallexample
716#ifdef MOTOROLA
717#define TARGET_VERSION \
718 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
719#else
720#define TARGET_VERSION \
721 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
722#endif
723@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 724@end defmac
feca2ed3 725
2b7e2984 726@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
74f7912a 727This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
2b7e2984
SE
728but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
729pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
730attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
74f7912a
JR
731when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
732actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
2b7e2984
SE
733@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
734@end deftypefn
735
c7b5e395 736@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
737This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
738but is only used in the C
c7b5e395
GK
739language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
740used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
741frontends.
742@end defmac
743
3020190e 744@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
feca2ed3 745Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
746various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
747options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
748options are processed once
feca2ed3 749just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e
JM
750of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
751options passed explicily.
feca2ed3 752
3020190e 753This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a51fa0f4
MM
754options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
755@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 756@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 757
7e4aae92
JM
758@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
759Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
760@end deftypefn
761
128dc8e2
JM
762@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
763Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
764@end deftypefn
765
9ddb66ef 766@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_HELP (void)
67e6ba46
NC
767This hook is called in response to the user invoking
768@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
769chance to display extra information on the target specific command
770line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
771@end deftypefn
772
3bd36029
RS
773@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
774Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
775during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
776the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
777can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
778and @code{nomips16} attributes.
779
780Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
781registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
782operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
783in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
784significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
785for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
786switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
787
788Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
789is 0.
790@end defmac
791
414c4dc4
NC
792@node Per-Function Data
793@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
794@cindex per-function data
795@cindex data structures
796
797If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
798provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
799using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
800nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
801when another one comes along.
802
803GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
804contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
805structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
806@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
807to their own specific data.
808
809If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
e2500fed
GK
810@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
811This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
812@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
414c4dc4
NC
813
814One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
815RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
816RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
817function, for level 0.
818
aee96fe9 819Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
414c4dc4
NC
820all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
821function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
822stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
823stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
02f52e19 824@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
414c4dc4
NC
825the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
826single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
827longer supported.
828
a2c4f8e0 829@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
c21cd8b1 830Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
414c4dc4 831is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
c21cd8b1 832The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
833function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
834@end defmac
414c4dc4 835
a2c4f8e0
ZW
836@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
837If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
838function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
839target to perform any target specific initialization of the
840@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
841used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
414c4dc4 842
8a36672b 843@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
e2500fed 844Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
a9429e29 845GC allocation, including the structure itself.
a2c4f8e0 846@end deftypevar
414c4dc4 847
feca2ed3
JW
848@node Storage Layout
849@section Storage Layout
850@cindex storage layout
851
852Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
853alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
854expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
855@xref{Run-time Target}.
856
a2c4f8e0 857@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
858Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
859byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
860This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
861bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
862be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
863macro need not be a constant.
864
865This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
866bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
a2c4f8e0 867@end defmac
feca2ed3 868
a2c4f8e0 869@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
870Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
871word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 872@end defmac
feca2ed3 873
a2c4f8e0 874@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
875Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
876most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
a3a15b4d 877memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
feca2ed3
JW
878order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
879macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 880@end defmac
feca2ed3 881
a2c4f8e0 882@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
883Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
884@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
885containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
886have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
887
888You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
889multi-word integers.
a2c4f8e0 890@end defmac
feca2ed3 891
a2c4f8e0 892@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
feca2ed3 893Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
5c60f03d 894unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
a2c4f8e0 895@end defmac
feca2ed3 896
a2c4f8e0 897@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
e81dd381
KG
898Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
899is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 900@end defmac
feca2ed3 901
a2c4f8e0 902@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
903Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 906@end defmac
feca2ed3 907
a2c4f8e0 908@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
c4336539
PB
909Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
910register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
a2c4f8e0 911@end defmac
feca2ed3 912
a2c4f8e0 913@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
914Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
915@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
916smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 917@end defmac
feca2ed3 918
a2c4f8e0 919@defmac POINTER_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
920Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
921width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
2465bf76
KG
922you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
923a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 924@end defmac
feca2ed3 925
a2c4f8e0 926@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4923a230
RS
927A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
928@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
929greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
930should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
931is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
932@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
933
934You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
935and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
a2c4f8e0 936@end defmac
feca2ed3 937
a2c4f8e0 938@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
939A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
940is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
941stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
942scalar type.
943
944On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
945register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
946@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
947cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
948floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
949counterparts.
950
951For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
952However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
953either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
954the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
955sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
956@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
957
958Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
a2c4f8e0 959@end defmac
feca2ed3 960
9ddb66ef 961@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
cde0f3fd
PB
962Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
963function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
964and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
965change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
966pointer} types.
967
666e3ceb
PB
968@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
969return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
970@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
971If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
972which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
973then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
974the signedness may be different.
975
cde0f3fd
PB
976The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
977also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
978if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
61f71b34 979@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 980
a2c4f8e0 981@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
982Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
983bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
984regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
985size of an integer.
a2c4f8e0 986@end defmac
feca2ed3 987
a2c4f8e0 988@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
989Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
990stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
991desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
992if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
993this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 994@end defmac
c795bca9 995
a2c4f8e0 996@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
997Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
998stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
999is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1000macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1001@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 1002@end defmac
feca2ed3 1003
2e3f842f
L
1004@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1005Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1006from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1007to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1008@end defmac
1009
a2c4f8e0 1010@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3 1011Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
a2c4f8e0 1012@end defmac
feca2ed3 1013
a2c4f8e0 1014@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
c4f46fde
DD
1015Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1016bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1017just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
a2c4f8e0 1018@end defmac
feca2ed3 1019
95331614
OH
1020@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1021Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1022provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1023@end defmac
1024
6e4f1168
L
1025@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1026Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1027not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1028@end defmac
1029
a2c4f8e0 1030@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
861bb6c1
JL
1031If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1032object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1033nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1034on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
a2c4f8e0 1035@end defmac
861bb6c1 1036
a2c4f8e0 1037@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
11cf4d18
JJ
1038Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1039machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1040structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1041by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1042@end defmac
feca2ed3 1043
a2c4f8e0 1044@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
feca2ed3 1045An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
ad9335eb
JJ
1046alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1047@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1048alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1049field alignment has not been set by the
1050@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1051@end defmac
feca2ed3 1052
2e3f842f
L
1053@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1054Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1055to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1056
1057If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1058
1059@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1060@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1061@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1062@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1063@end defmac
1064
a2c4f8e0 1065@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1066Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1067Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1068@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1069the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
11d90e2d
CD
1070
1071On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1072the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1073a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1074On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1075@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
a2c4f8e0 1076@end defmac
feca2ed3 1077
a2c4f8e0 1078@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1079If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
8a198bd2
JW
1080the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1081the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
feca2ed3
JW
1082macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1083
1084If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1085
1086@findex strcpy
1087One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1088make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1089arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1090constants to character arrays can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1091@end defmac
feca2ed3 1092
a2c4f8e0 1093@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
feca2ed3
JW
1094If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1095that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1096@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1097have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1098align the object.
1099
1100If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1101
1102The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1103constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1104constants can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1105@end defmac
feca2ed3 1106
a2c4f8e0 1107@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1108If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
d16790f2
JW
1109the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1110the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1111macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1112
1113If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1114
1115One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1116make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad
JR
1117
1118It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 1119@end defmac
d16790f2 1120
76fe54f0
L
1121@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1122If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1123@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1124and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1125have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1126align the slot.
1127
1128If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1129@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1130be used.
1131
1132This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1133of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad
JR
1134
1135It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76fe54f0
L
1136@end defmac
1137
9bfaf89d
JJ
1138@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1139If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1140variable @var{decl}.
1141
1142If this macro is not defined, then
1143@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1144is used.
1145
1146One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1147make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad
JR
1148
1149It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
9bfaf89d
JJ
1150@end defmac
1151
ae58e548
JJ
1152@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1153If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1154for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1155@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1156
1157If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1158@end defmac
1159
a2c4f8e0 1160@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
c771326b 1161Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
feca2ed3
JW
1162empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1163
78d55cc8 1164If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1165@end defmac
feca2ed3 1166
a2c4f8e0 1167@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
1168Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1169Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1170
1171If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1172@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1173@end defmac
feca2ed3 1174
a2c4f8e0 1175@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1176Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1177if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1178go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
a2c4f8e0 1179@end defmac
feca2ed3 1180
a2c4f8e0 1181@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
feca2ed3 1182Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
c771326b 1183alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
feca2ed3 1184
8dc65b6e
MM
1185The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1186@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1187structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1188that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1189that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1190
1191Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1192@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1193four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1194not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1195
1196An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1197structure.
feca2ed3
JW
1198
1199If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1200a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1201
1202Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
c771326b 1203bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
feca2ed3
JW
1204support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1205@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1206
c771326b 1207The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
feca2ed3
JW
1208@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1209Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1210
c771326b 1211Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
feca2ed3
JW
1212@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1213@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1214
a3a15b4d 1215If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
c771326b 1216bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
feca2ed3
JW
1217what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1218
3ab51846 1219@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1220struct foo1
1221@{
1222 char x;
1223 char :0;
1224 char y;
1225@};
1226
1227struct foo2
1228@{
1229 char x;
1230 int :0;
1231 char y;
1232@};
1233
1234main ()
1235@{
1236 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1237 sizeof (struct foo1));
1238 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1239 sizeof (struct foo2));
1240 exit (0);
1241@}
3ab51846 1242@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1243
1244If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1245get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1246@end defmac
feca2ed3 1247
a2c4f8e0 1248@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f913c102
AO
1249Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1250to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
a2c4f8e0 1251@end defmac
feca2ed3 1252
b5bde9ff 1253@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
13c1cd82
PB
1254When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1255whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1256structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1257the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1258@end deftypefn
1259
b5bde9ff 1260@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
c2a64439
PB
1261This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1262should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1263these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1264
1265The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1266@end deftypefn
1267
a2c4f8e0 1268@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
31a02448 1269Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
9f6dc500
HPN
1270@code{BLKMODE}.
1271
182e515e
AH
1272If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1273mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1274case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1275retain the field's mode.
1276
8d8da227 1277Normally, this is not needed.
a2c4f8e0 1278@end defmac
9f6dc500 1279
a2c4f8e0 1280@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
0003feb2
VM
1281Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1282by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1283way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
feca2ed3
JW
1284@var{specified}.
1285
1286The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1287the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
a2c4f8e0 1288@end defmac
feca2ed3 1289
a2c4f8e0 1290@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1291An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1292machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1293this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1294appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1295(DImode)} is assumed.
a2c4f8e0 1296@end defmac
feca2ed3 1297
a2c4f8e0 1298@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
73c8090f 1299If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1300specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1301@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1302@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1303@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1304having its mode specified.
73c8090f
DE
1305
1306You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1307would most commonly define this macro if the
1308@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
130964-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1310@end defmac
73c8090f 1311
a2c4f8e0 1312@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
39403d82
DE
1313If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1314specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1315@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1316
1317You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1318You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1319pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1320@end defmac
39403d82 1321
9ddb66ef 1322@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1323This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1324of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1325@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1326targets.
1327@end deftypefn
1328
9ddb66ef 1329@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1330This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1331of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1332@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1333targets.
1334@end deftypefn
1335
8a9a2486
JR
1336@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1337Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1338The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1339@end deftypefn
1340
a2c4f8e0 1341@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
3fcaac1d 1342If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
4099e2c2 1343mode is towards zero.
3fcaac1d 1344
4099e2c2
UW
1345Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1346floating-point arithmetic.
3fcaac1d
RS
1347
1348Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
a2c4f8e0 1349@end defmac
3fcaac1d 1350
a2c4f8e0 1351@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
4226378a 1352This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
3fcaac1d
RS
1353bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1354exponent for normal numbers instead.
1355
4099e2c2 1356Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
3fcaac1d
RS
1357floating-point arithmetic.
1358
1359The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
a2c4f8e0 1360@end defmac
feca2ed3 1361
9ddb66ef 1362@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f913c102
AO
1363This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1364@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1365Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1366unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1367different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1368alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1369bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1370the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1371(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
6335b0aa 1372another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f913c102 1373other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
e4850f36
DR
1374
1375When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1376of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1377bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1378and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8a36672b
JM
1379chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1380size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
e4850f36
DR
1381alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1382
1383If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8a36672b 1384the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
e4850f36
DR
1385used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1386precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1387may affect its placement.
f913c102
AO
1388@end deftypefn
1389
9ddb66ef 1390@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9a8ce21f 1391Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
9a8ce21f
JG
1392@end deftypefn
1393
9ddb66ef 1394@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
ab22c1fa
CF
1395Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1396@end deftypefn
1397
e41b2a33
PB
1398@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1399This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1400to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1401For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1402for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1403registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1404usage.
1405@end deftypefn
1406
1407@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1408This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1409that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1410@end deftypefn
1411
9ddb66ef 1412@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
608063c3
JB
1413If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1414uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1415to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1416mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1417the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1418not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1419for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1420return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1421string constant.
f18eca82
ZL
1422
1423Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1424qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1425fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1426is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1427length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1428ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1429@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1430@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1431code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1432@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1433codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1434spaces in your string.
1435
608063c3
JB
1436This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1437name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1438can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1439before mangling.
1440
f18eca82
ZL
1441The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1442appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1443types.
1444@end deftypefn
1445
feca2ed3
JW
1446@node Type Layout
1447@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1448
1449These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1450basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1451the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1452languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1453
a2c4f8e0 1454@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1455A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1456target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1457@end defmac
feca2ed3 1458
a2c4f8e0 1459@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1460A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1461target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1462(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1463unit.)
a2c4f8e0 1464@end defmac
feca2ed3 1465
a2c4f8e0 1466@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1467A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1468target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1469@end defmac
feca2ed3 1470
a2c4f8e0 1471@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1615c261 1472On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
8a36672b 1473@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1615c261
RK
1474that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1475the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1476value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1477@end defmac
1615c261 1478
a2c4f8e0 1479@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1480A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1481target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
047c1c92 1482words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
feca2ed3 1483macro must be at least 64.
a2c4f8e0 1484@end defmac
feca2ed3 1485
a2c4f8e0 1486@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3 1487A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
c294bd99
HPN
1488target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1489@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1490@end defmac
feca2ed3 1491
a2c4f8e0 1492@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
3d1ad9e5
JM
1493A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1494C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1495this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1496@end defmac
68eb4fb9 1497
a2c4f8e0 1498@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1499A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1500target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1501@end defmac
feca2ed3 1502
a2c4f8e0 1503@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1504A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1505target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1506words.
a2c4f8e0 1507@end defmac
feca2ed3 1508
a2c4f8e0 1509@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1510A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1511the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1512words.
a2c4f8e0 1513@end defmac
feca2ed3 1514
325217ed
CF
1515@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1516A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1517the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1518@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1519@end defmac
1520
1521@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1522A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1523the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1524@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1525@end defmac
1526
1527@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1528A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1529the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1530@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1531@end defmac
1532
1533@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1534A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1535the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1537@end defmac
1538
1539@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1540A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1541the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1542@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1543@end defmac
1544
1545@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1546A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1547the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1548@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1549@end defmac
1550
1551@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1552A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1553the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1554@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1555@end defmac
1556
1557@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1558A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1559the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1560@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1561@end defmac
1562
4e9db8b2
SE
1563@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1564Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1565if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1566@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1567default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1568@end defmac
1569
1570@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1571Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
4e9db8b2
SE
1572@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1573@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1574anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
4e9db8b2
SE
1575or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1576otherwise it is 0.
1577@end defmac
1578
1579@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
083cad55 1580Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
4e9db8b2
SE
1581@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1582anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1583is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1584@end defmac
1585
1586@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
083cad55 1587Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
4e9db8b2
SE
1588@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1589anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1590is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1591@end defmac
1592
4a73d865
JM
1593@defmac SF_SIZE
1594@defmacx DF_SIZE
1595@defmacx XF_SIZE
1596@defmacx TF_SIZE
1597Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1598@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1599if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1600@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1601for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1602@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1603@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
4a73d865
JM
1604@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1605@end defmac
1606
a2c4f8e0 1607@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
d57a4b98
RH
1608A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1609assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1610default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1611@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
a2c4f8e0 1612@end defmac
aaa2e8ef 1613
a2c4f8e0 1614@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
e9a25f70
JL
1615A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1616supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1617value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1618If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1619is the default.
a2c4f8e0 1620@end defmac
e9a25f70 1621
a2c4f8e0 1622@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
1623An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1624@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
630d3d5a
JM
1625always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1626and @option{-funsigned-char}.
a2c4f8e0 1627@end defmac
feca2ed3 1628
221ee7c9
KH
1629@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1630This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1631@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1632of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
35afa569
KH
1633@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1634
221ee7c9
KH
1635The default is to return false.
1636@end deftypefn
35afa569 1637
a2c4f8e0 1638@defmac SIZE_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1639A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1640for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1641contents of the string.
1642
1643The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1644spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1645appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1646of the data type names defined in the function
1647@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1648omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1649crash on startup.
1650
1651If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1652int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1653@end defmac
feca2ed3 1654
a2c4f8e0 1655@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1656A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1657for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1658@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1659@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1660
1661If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1662@end defmac
feca2ed3 1663
a2c4f8e0 1664@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1665A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1666for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1667the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1668information.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1671@end defmac
feca2ed3 1672
a2c4f8e0 1673@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1674A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1675characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1676@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
a2c4f8e0 1677@end defmac
feca2ed3 1678
a2c4f8e0 1679@defmac WINT_TYPE
1a67c7d3
JL
1680A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1681use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1682@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1683contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1684information.
1685
1686If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1687@end defmac
1a67c7d3 1688
a2c4f8e0 1689@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1690A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1691can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1692The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1693string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1694
1695If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1696@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1697much precision as @code{long long int}.
a2c4f8e0 1698@end defmac
b15ad712 1699
a2c4f8e0 1700@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1701A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1702can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1703type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1704of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1705
1706If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1707@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1708unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1709int}.
a2c4f8e0 1710@end defmac
b15ad712 1711
207bf79d
JM
1712@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1713@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1714@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1718@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1721@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1722@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1723@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1724@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1725@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1726@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1727@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1728@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1729@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1730@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1731@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1732@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1733@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1734@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1735@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1736@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1737@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1738@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1739C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1740@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1741@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1742@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1743@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1744@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1745@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1746@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1747@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1748@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1749
1750If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1751type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1752@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1753to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1754these macros are null pointers.
1755@end defmac
1756
a2c4f8e0 1757@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
f3c55c97
AO
1758The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1759that looks like:
1760
3ab51846 1761@smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1762 struct @{
1763 union @{
1764 void (*fn)();
1765 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1766 @};
1767 ptrdiff_t delta;
1768 @};
3ab51846 1769@end smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1770
1771@noindent
1772The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1773will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1774Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1775always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1776distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1777platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1778that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1779the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1780
1781GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1782this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1783However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1784set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1785bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1786address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1787architecture, you should define this macro to
1788@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1789
1790In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1791in which function addresses are always even, according to
1792@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1793@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
a2c4f8e0 1794@end defmac
67231816 1795
a2c4f8e0 1796@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
67231816 1797Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
f282ffb3 1798macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
67231816
RH
1799instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1800function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
f282ffb3 1801data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
67231816
RH
1802pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1803
1804If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1805of words that the function descriptor occupies.
a2c4f8e0 1806@end defmac
a6f5e048 1807
a2c4f8e0 1808@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
a6f5e048
RH
1809By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1810is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1811the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1812when special alignment is necessary. */
a2c4f8e0 1813@end defmac
a6f5e048 1814
a2c4f8e0 1815@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
a6f5e048
RH
1816There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1817zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1818specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1819of words in each data entry.
a2c4f8e0 1820@end defmac
b2b263e1 1821
feca2ed3
JW
1822@node Registers
1823@section Register Usage
1824@cindex register usage
1825
1826This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1827has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1828
1829The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1830done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1831on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1832For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1833For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1834
1835@menu
6ccde948
RW
1836* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1837* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1838* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1839* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1840* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
feca2ed3
JW
1841@end menu
1842
1843@node Register Basics
1844@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1845
1846@c prevent bad page break with this line
1847Registers have various characteristics.
1848
a2c4f8e0 1849@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
feca2ed3
JW
1850Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1851numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1852pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1853@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 1854@end defmac
feca2ed3 1855
a2c4f8e0 1856@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1857@cindex fixed register
1858An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1859all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1860general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1861pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1862register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1863machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1864and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1865
1866This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1867commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1868register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1869
1870The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1871the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1872by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
630d3d5a
JM
1873the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1874@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
a2c4f8e0 1875@end defmac
feca2ed3 1876
a2c4f8e0 1877@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1878@cindex call-used register
1879@cindex call-clobbered register
1880@cindex call-saved register
1881Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1882clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1883registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1884available for general allocation of values that must live across
1885function calls.
1886
1887If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1888automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1889exit, if the register is used within the function.
a2c4f8e0 1890@end defmac
feca2ed3 1891
a2c4f8e0 1892@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
fc1296b7
AM
1893@cindex call-used register
1894@cindex call-clobbered register
1895@cindex call-saved register
f282ffb3
JM
1896Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1897that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
fc1296b7 1898(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
f282ffb3 1899This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
fc1296b7 1900of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1901@end defmac
fc1296b7 1902
a2c4f8e0 1903@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1e326708
MH
1904@cindex call-used register
1905@cindex call-clobbered register
1906@cindex call-saved register
df2a54e9 1907A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1e326708
MH
1908value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1909call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1910macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1911preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
a2c4f8e0 1912@end defmac
1e326708 1913
feca2ed3
JW
1914@findex fixed_regs
1915@findex call_used_regs
a2c4f8e0
ZW
1916@findex global_regs
1917@findex reg_names
1918@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1919@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1920This hook may conditionally modify five variables
055177dc 1921@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
c237e94a
ZW
1922@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1923any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1924of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1925@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1926@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1927called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1928@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
055177dc 1929from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
c237e94a 1930@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
630d3d5a 1931@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
c237e94a
ZW
1932@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1933command options have been applied.
feca2ed3 1934
feca2ed3
JW
1935@cindex disabling certain registers
1936@cindex controlling register usage
1937If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1938flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1939@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
161d7b59 1940registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
97488870
R
1941the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1942to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
feca2ed3
JW
1943is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1944
1945(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1946of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1947controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1948these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1949@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 1950
a2c4f8e0 1951@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
feca2ed3
JW
1952Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1953expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1954corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1955function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1956outbound register.
a2c4f8e0 1957@end defmac
feca2ed3 1958
a2c4f8e0 1959@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
feca2ed3
JW
1960Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1961expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1962corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1963function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1964register.
a2c4f8e0 1965@end defmac
feca2ed3 1966
a2c4f8e0 1967@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
fa80e43d
JL
1968Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1969expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1970register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1971need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1972gotos.
a2c4f8e0 1973@end defmac
fa80e43d 1974
a2c4f8e0 1975@defmac PC_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
1976If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1977register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
a2c4f8e0 1978@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
1979
1980@node Allocation Order
1981@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1982@cindex order of register allocation
1983@cindex register allocation order
1984
1985@c prevent bad page break with this line
1986Registers are allocated in order.
1987
a2c4f8e0 1988@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3 1989If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
a3a15b4d 1990numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
feca2ed3
JW
1991to use them (from most preferred to least).
1992
1993If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1994(all else being equal).
1995
1996One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1997registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1998instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1999machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
956d6950 2000the highest numbered allocable register first.
a2c4f8e0 2001@end defmac
feca2ed3 2002
5a733826 2003@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3
JW
2004A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2005hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2006
2007Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2008Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2009register; and so on.
2010
2011The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2012@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2013
2014On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 2015@end defmac
feca2ed3 2016
5a733826
BS
2017@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2018Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2019prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2020using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2021allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2022call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2023should be defined.
2024@end defmac
2025
058e97ec
VM
2026@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2027In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2028Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2029If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2030based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2031be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2032value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2033to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2034
2035On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2036@end defmac
2037
feca2ed3
JW
2038@node Values in Registers
2039@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2040
2041This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2042(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2043consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2044
a2c4f8e0 2045@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2046A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2047at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
79e168da
DD
2048@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2049cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2050and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
feca2ed3
JW
2051
2052On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2053definition of this macro is
2054
2055@smallexample
2056#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2057 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
32bd3974 2058 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
feca2ed3 2059@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2060@end defmac
feca2ed3 2061
8521c414
JM
2062@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2063A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2064in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2065in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2066multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2067this mode by the number of registers returned by
2068@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2069
2070For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2071registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2072nonzero.
2073
2074This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
f1f4e530 2075@code{subreg_get_info}
8521c414
JM
2076would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2077represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2078@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2079registers and so not be representable.
2080@end defmac
2081
2082@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2083For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2084@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2085returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2086including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2087@end defmac
2088
ca0b6e3b
EB
2089@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2090Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2091of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2092should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2093used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2094happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2095floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2096@end defmac
2097
a2c4f8e0 2098@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2099A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2100of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2101registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2102are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2103
2104@smallexample
2105#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2106@end smallexample
2107
e9a25f70
JL
2108You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2109because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
feca2ed3
JW
2110
2111@cindex register pairs
2112On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
e9a25f70
JL
2113register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2114odd register numbers for such modes.
feca2ed3
JW
2115
2116The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2117@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
e9a25f70
JL
2118register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2119value into the register and back out not alter it.
feca2ed3 2120
e9a25f70
JL
2121Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2122all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
feca2ed3
JW
2123@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2124you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2125is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2126and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2127to be tieable.
2128
2129Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2130Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2131in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2132can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2133mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2134registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2135
2136On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2137modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2138registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2139non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2140@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2141floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2142normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2143unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2144register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2145
2146The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2147they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2148instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2149@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2150constraints for those instructions.
2151
2152On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2153so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2154register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2155floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2156be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
a2c4f8e0 2157@end defmac
feca2ed3 2158
150c9fe8
KH
2159@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2160A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2161@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2162
2163One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2164another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2165handler.
2166
2167The default is always nonzero.
2168@end defmac
2169
a2c4f8e0 2170@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
e9a25f70 2171A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
956d6950 2172@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
feca2ed3
JW
2173
2174If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
e9a25f70
JL
2175@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2176any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2177should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2178this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
956d6950 2179accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
e9a25f70
JL
2180
2181You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
a3a15b4d 2182possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
e9a25f70 2183allocation.
a2c4f8e0 2184@end defmac
7506f491 2185
dbc42c44
AS
2186@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2187This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2188@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2189
2190One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2191is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2192
2193The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2194@end deftypefn
2195
a2c4f8e0 2196@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
7506f491 2197Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a89608cb 2198registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
7506f491 2199@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
a2c4f8e0 2200@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
2201
2202@node Leaf Functions
2203@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2204
2205@cindex leaf functions
2206@cindex functions, leaf
2207On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2208more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2209means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2210are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2211normally arrive.
2212
2213The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2214other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2215registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2216function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2217handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2218functions''.
2219
a3a15b4d 2220GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
feca2ed3
JW
2221suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2222registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2223accomplish this.
2224
a2c4f8e0 2225@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7d167afd 2226Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
feca2ed3
JW
2227contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2228function treatment.
2229
2230If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2231registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
a3a15b4d 2232GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
feca2ed3
JW
2233used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2234in this vector.
2235
2236Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2237the treatment of leaf functions.
a2c4f8e0 2238@end defmac
feca2ed3 2239
a2c4f8e0 2240@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2241A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2242should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2243
2244If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
630d3d5a 2245function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
feca2ed3
JW
2246will cause the compiler to abort.
2247
2248Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2249treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2250this.
a2c4f8e0 2251@end defmac
feca2ed3 2252
54ff41b7
JW
2253@findex current_function_is_leaf
2254@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
c237e94a
ZW
2255@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2256@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2257specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2258which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2259set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
08c148a8
NB
2260compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2261@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2262functions which only use leaf registers.
9ac617d4
EB
2263@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2264that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2265@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
feca2ed3
JW
2266@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2267@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2268
2269@node Stack Registers
2270@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2271
2272There are special features to handle computers where some of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2273``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2274pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2275stack.
feca2ed3 2276
a3a15b4d 2277Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2278they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2279support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2280point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2281stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2282@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2283with it, as well as defining these macros.
2284
2285@defmac STACK_REGS
feca2ed3 2286Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
a2c4f8e0 2287@end defmac
feca2ed3 2288
1833192f
VM
2289@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2290This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2291the machine has any stack-like registers.
2292@end defmac
2293
a2c4f8e0 2294@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2295The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2296of the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2297@end defmac
feca2ed3 2298
a2c4f8e0 2299@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2300The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2301the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2302@end defmac
feca2ed3 2303
feca2ed3
JW
2304@node Register Classes
2305@section Register Classes
2306@cindex register class definitions
2307@cindex class definitions, register
2308
2309On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2310For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2311certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2312restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2313
2314You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2315which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2316that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2317
2318@findex ALL_REGS
2319@findex NO_REGS
2320In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2321class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2322class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2323union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2324
2325@findex GENERAL_REGS
2326One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2327terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2328@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2329the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2330to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2331
2332Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2333then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2334
2335The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2336constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2337You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2338them in operand constraints.
2339
2340You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2341instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2342either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2343certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2344which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2345
2346You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2347classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2348contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2349in their union.
2350
2351When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2352certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2353Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2354a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2355specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2356
2357Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2358instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2359each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2360mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2361single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2362this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2363instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2364single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2365@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2366
a2c4f8e0 2367@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2eac577f
JM
2368An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2369as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2370must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
feca2ed3
JW
2371@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2372tells how many classes there are.
2373
2374Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2375the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2376in many of the tables described below.
a2c4f8e0 2377@end deftp
feca2ed3 2378
a2c4f8e0 2379@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
feca2ed3
JW
2380The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2381
3ab51846 2382@smallexample
feca2ed3 2383#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
3ab51846 2384@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2385@end defmac
feca2ed3 2386
a2c4f8e0 2387@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
2388An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2389constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
a2c4f8e0 2390@end defmac
feca2ed3 2391
a2c4f8e0 2392@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
feca2ed3
JW
2393An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2394which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2395@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2396register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2397
2398When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2399Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2400several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2401for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
7c272079
MP
2402In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2403registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2404so on.
a2c4f8e0 2405@end defmac
feca2ed3 2406
a2c4f8e0 2407@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2408A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2409@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2410which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2411register.
a2c4f8e0 2412@end defmac
feca2ed3 2413
a2c4f8e0 2414@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2415A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2416base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2417which is the register value plus a displacement.
a2c4f8e0 2418@end defmac
feca2ed3 2419
a2c4f8e0 2420@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
3dcc68a4 2421This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
c0478a66 2422the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
3dcc68a4
NC
2423@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2424@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2425@end defmac
3dcc68a4 2426
888d2cd6
DJ
2427@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2428A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2429base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2430register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2431addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2432@end defmac
2433
c4963a0a
BS
2434@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2435A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2436base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2437context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2438the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2439address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2440@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2441index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2442@end defmac
2443
a2c4f8e0 2444@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2445A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2446index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2447address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2448added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
a2c4f8e0 2449@end defmac
feca2ed3 2450
a2c4f8e0 2451@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3 2452A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
1c62e8f2 2453suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
a2c4f8e0 2454@end defmac
feca2ed3 2455
a2c4f8e0 2456@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
861bb6c1
JL
2457A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2458that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2459@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2460reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2461you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
ab873839
RW
2462@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2463addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2464@code{address_operand}.
a2c4f8e0 2465@end defmac
861bb6c1 2466
888d2cd6
DJ
2467@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2468A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2469use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2470memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2471pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2472define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2473than other base register uses.
c4963a0a
BS
2474
2475Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2476@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2477@end defmac
2478
2479@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
ab873839
RW
2480A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2481that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2482appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2483immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2484address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2485@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2486corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
c4963a0a 2487@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
ab873839 2488that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
888d2cd6
DJ
2489@end defmac
2490
a2c4f8e0 2491@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
2492A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2493suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2494either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2495allocated such a hard register.
2496
2497The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2498the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2499two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2500labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2501labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2502may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2503looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2504only if neither labeling works.
a2c4f8e0 2505@end defmac
feca2ed3 2506
fba42e24
AS
2507@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2508A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2509to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2510@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2511another, smaller class.
2512
2513The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2514
2515Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2516example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2517for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2518@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2519Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2520
2521One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2522@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2523loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2524force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2525immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2526instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2527register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2528@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2529into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2530@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2531of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2532
2533If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2534through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2535to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2536reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2537this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2538the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2539@end deftypefn
2540
a2c4f8e0 2541@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2542A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2545another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2546safe:
2547
3ab51846 2548@smallexample
feca2ed3 2549#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
3ab51846 2550@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
2551
2552Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2553example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2554for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2555@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2556Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2557
222a2f1a
GK
2558One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2559@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2560loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2561force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2562immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2563instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2564register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2565@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2566into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2567@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2568of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
b5c82fa1
PB
2569
2570If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2571through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2572to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2573reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2574this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2575the SSE registers (and vice versa).
a2c4f8e0 2576@end defmac
feca2ed3 2577
a2c4f8e0 2578@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2579Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2580input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2581@var{class}, unchanged.
b5c82fa1
PB
2582
2583You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2584reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2585@end defmac
feca2ed3 2586
abd26bfb
AS
2587@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2588Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2589input reloads.
2590
2591The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2592argument.
2593
2594You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2595reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2596@end deftypefn
2597
a2c4f8e0 2598@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2599A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2600to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2601@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2602ordinarily be used.
2603
2604Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2605there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2606
2607The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2608smaller class.
2609
2610Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2611require the macro to do something nontrivial.
a2c4f8e0 2612@end defmac
feca2ed3 2613
a87cf97e 2614@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
feca2ed3
JW
2615Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2616from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2617@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
8a99f6f9
R
2618from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2619term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2620directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2621register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2622destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2623source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2624reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2625and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2626intermediate register still holds the required value.
2627
2628Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2629allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2630register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2631address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2632when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
e4ae5e77 2633as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
8a99f6f9
R
2634that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2635describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2636these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2637of the scratch register(s).
2638
2639In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2640
2641For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
9bdf23b2 2642and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
8a99f6f9 2643@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
9bdf23b2 2644hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
8a99f6f9
R
2645needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2646
2647If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2648an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2649return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2650If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2651If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2652that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2653
2654If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2655perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2656closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2657required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2658copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2659
2660You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2661in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2662and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2663for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2664single-register-class
2665@c [later: or memory]
2666output constraint.
2667
2668When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2669hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2670register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2671have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2672
2673@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2674@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2675@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2676@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2677@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2678@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2679@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2680@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2681
2682
2683@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2684pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2685Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2686in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2687
2688Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2689currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2690to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2691
2692@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2693copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2694(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2695Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2696of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2697forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2698@end deftypefn
2699
2700@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2701@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2702@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
083cad55 2703These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
8a99f6f9
R
2704@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2705
2706These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2707target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2708reload phase that it may
feca2ed3
JW
2709need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2710register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2711register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
8a99f6f9 2712you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
feca2ed3
JW
2713largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2714intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2715
2716If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2717intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
8a99f6f9
R
2718was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2719class required. If the
2720requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2721@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
feca2ed3
JW
2722macros identically.
2723
2724The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2725Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2726can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2727@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2728macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2729
2730If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
8a99f6f9 2731intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
feca2ed3 2732@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
8a99f6f9 2733(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
feca2ed3
JW
2734implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2735@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2736register.
2737
8a99f6f9
R
2738These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2739register that
feca2ed3
JW
2740contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2741class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2742value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2743register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2744Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2745
2746@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2747pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
630d3d5a 2748Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
feca2ed3
JW
2749in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2750
2751These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2752registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2753registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2754would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
a8154559 2755the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
feca2ed3
JW
2756intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2757general registers.
a2c4f8e0 2758@end defmac
feca2ed3 2759
a2c4f8e0 2760@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
feca2ed3
JW
2761Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2762to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
df2a54e9 2763those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
feca2ed3
JW
2764@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2765class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2766and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2767
2768Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
a2c4f8e0 2769@end defmac
feca2ed3 2770
a2c4f8e0 2771@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2772Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2773allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2774If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2775defined by this macro.
2776
2777Do not define this macro if you do not define
2778@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
a2c4f8e0 2779@end defmac
feca2ed3 2780
a2c4f8e0 2781@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2782When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2783registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2784hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2785load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2786same as that of @var{mode}.
2787
2788This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2789bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2790in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2791registers.
2792
2793However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2794the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2795differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2796widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2797suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2798details.
2799
2800Do not define this macro if you do not define
2801@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2802is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
a2c4f8e0 2803@end defmac
feca2ed3 2804
07b8f0a8
AS
2805@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2806A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2807to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2808registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2809
2810The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2811has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2812default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2813if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2814hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2815@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2816@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2817register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2818you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2819the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2820allocation.
2821@end deftypefn
2822
a2c4f8e0 2823@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2824A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2825of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2826
2827This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2828the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2829should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2830@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2831
2832This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2833in the reload pass.
a2c4f8e0 2834@end defmac
feca2ed3 2835
a2c4f8e0 2836@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
b0c42aed
JH
2837If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2838a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
feca2ed3
JW
2839
2840For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
57694e40 2841floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
feca2ed3 2842Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
57694e40 2843does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
cff9f8d5
AH
2844register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2845as below:
02188693 2846
3ab51846 2847@smallexample
b0c42aed
JH
2848#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2849 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2850 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
3ab51846 2851@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2852@end defmac
feca2ed3 2853
a87cf97e 2854@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const reg_class_t *} TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES (void)
76e68dca 2855Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
058e97ec
VM
2856(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2857classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
af9253a1 2858purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
4cda38d5 2859possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
76e68dca
RS
2860The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2861
db1a8d98
VM
2862The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2863have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2864the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2865
76e68dca
RS
2866This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2867options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2868@code{target_reinit}.
058e97ec 2869
76e68dca
RS
2870The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2871otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2872macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
7db7ed3c
VM
2873allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2874the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
d5fabb58
JM
2875
2876This hook must not be modified from @code{NULL} to non-@code{NULL} or
2877vice versa by command-line option processing.
76e68dca
RS
2878@end deftypefn
2879
2880@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2881See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
058e97ec
VM
2882@end defmac
2883
f38840db
ZW
2884@node Old Constraints
2885@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2886@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2887@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2888
2889Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2890of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2891Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2892it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2893
2894@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2895For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2896@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2897constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2898you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2899constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2900DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2901to handle specially.
2902There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2903for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2904transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2905return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2906will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2907@end defmac
2908
2909@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2910A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2911letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2912value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2913the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2914corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2915to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2916@end defmac
2917
2918@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2919Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2920passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2921different variants.
2922@end defmac
feca2ed3 2923
a2c4f8e0 2924@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
e119b68c
MM
2925A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2926letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2927particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2928letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2929the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2930not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2931@var{value}.
a2c4f8e0 2932@end defmac
feca2ed3 2933
a2c4f8e0 2934@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
2935Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2936string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2937between different variants.
a2c4f8e0 2938@end defmac
97488870 2939
a2c4f8e0 2940@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
feca2ed3 2941A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
e119b68c
MM
2942letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2943(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
feca2ed3
JW
2944
2945If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2946@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2947range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2948letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2949
2950@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2951@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2952or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2953between these kinds.
a2c4f8e0 2954@end defmac
feca2ed3 2955
a2c4f8e0 2956@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
2957Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2958string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2959between different variants.
a2c4f8e0 2960@end defmac
97488870 2961
a2c4f8e0 2962@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
feca2ed3 2963A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
c2cba7a9
RH
2964letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2965memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
97488870
R
2966elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2967@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
c2cba7a9
RH
2968may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2969
2970If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2971if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2972constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
e119b68c 2973constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
feca2ed3 2974
c2cba7a9
RH
2975For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2976in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2977letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
feca2ed3
JW
2978@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2979a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2980alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2981does not include r0 on the output.
a2c4f8e0 2982@end defmac
ccfc6cc8 2983
a2c4f8e0 2984@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
2985Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2986in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2987variants.
a2c4f8e0 2988@end defmac
97488870 2989
a2c4f8e0 2990@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
ccfc6cc8
UW
2991A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2992letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2993be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2994
73774972 2995It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
97488870 2996at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
6ccde948 2997comprises a subset of all memory references including
73774972
EC
2998all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2999pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
ccfc6cc8
UW
3000type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3001
3002For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3003memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3004register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3005@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3006If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3007a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3008reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3009into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
e4ae5e77 3010an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 3011@end defmac
ccfc6cc8 3012
a2c4f8e0 3013@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
ccfc6cc8 3014A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
97488870
R
3015letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3016@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
ccfc6cc8
UW
3017be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3018
73774972 3019It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3a6e2189 3020at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
97488870 3021a subset of all memory addresses including
73774972
EC
3022all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3023pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
97488870 3024type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
ccfc6cc8
UW
3025
3026Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
73774972 3027be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
ccfc6cc8 3028analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
a2c4f8e0 3029@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3030
3031@node Stack and Calling
3032@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3033@cindex calling conventions
3034
3035@c prevent bad page break with this line
3036This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3037
3038@menu
3039* Frame Layout::
7c16328b 3040* Exception Handling::
861bb6c1 3041* Stack Checking::
feca2ed3
JW
3042* Frame Registers::
3043* Elimination::
3044* Stack Arguments::
3045* Register Arguments::
3046* Scalar Return::
3047* Aggregate Return::
3048* Caller Saves::
3049* Function Entry::
3050* Profiling::
91d231cb 3051* Tail Calls::
7d69de61 3052* Stack Smashing Protection::
feca2ed3
JW
3053@end menu
3054
3055@node Frame Layout
3056@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3057@cindex stack frame layout
3058@cindex frame layout
3059
3060@c prevent bad page break with this line
3061Here is the basic stack layout.
3062
a2c4f8e0 3063@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
3064Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3065pointer to a smaller address.
3066
d78aa55c 3067When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
feca2ed3
JW
3068compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3069definition used does not matter.
a2c4f8e0 3070@end defmac
feca2ed3 3071
a2c4f8e0 3072@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
918a6124
GK
3073This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3074on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
04a5176a 3075@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
918a6124
GK
3076
3077The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3078and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3079the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3080to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3081space for the next item on the stack.
3082
3083The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3084defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3085which is often wrong.
a2c4f8e0 3086@end defmac
918a6124 3087
a2c4f8e0 3088@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
a4d05547 3089Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
f62c8a5c 3090are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
a2c4f8e0 3091@end defmac
feca2ed3 3092
a2c4f8e0 3093@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
3094Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3095addresses on the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3096@end defmac
feca2ed3 3097
a2c4f8e0 3098@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
3099Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3100
3101If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3102subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3103Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3104value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3105@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3106@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
a2c4f8e0 3107@end defmac
feca2ed3 3108
a2c4f8e0 3109@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
95f3f59e 3110Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
0b4be7de 3111The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
95f3f59e 3112
0b4be7de 3113On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
95f3f59e
JDA
3114is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3115alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3116stack alignment and do it in the backend.
a2c4f8e0 3117@end defmac
95f3f59e 3118
a2c4f8e0 3119@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
3120Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3121outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3122zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3123
3124If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3125the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
a2c4f8e0 3126@end defmac
feca2ed3 3127
a2c4f8e0 3128@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3129Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3130address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3131function.
3132
3133If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3134the first argument's address.
a2c4f8e0 3135@end defmac
feca2ed3 3136
a2c4f8e0 3137@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3138Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3139on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3140
3141The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3142length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3143machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
a2c4f8e0 3144@end defmac
feca2ed3 3145
c6d01079
AK
3146@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3147A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
083cad55 3148stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
c8f27794
JW
3149@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3150default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
083cad55 3151elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
c8f27794 3152@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
c6d01079
AK
3153@end defmac
3154
a2c4f8e0 3155@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3
JW
3156A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3157frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3158@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3159itself.
3160
3161If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3162of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3163address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
a2c4f8e0 3164@end defmac
feca2ed3 3165
a2c4f8e0 3166@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
feca2ed3
JW
3167If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3168setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
981f6289 3169on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
0bc02db4
MS
3170before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3171define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3172@end defmac
0bc02db4 3173
9ddb66ef 3174@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
d6da68b9 3175This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
0bc02db4
MS
3176the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3177The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
d6da68b9 3178machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
0bc02db4 3179@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
d6da68b9 3180@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3181
224869d9
EB
3182@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3183A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3184address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3185of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3186You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3187as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3188@end defmac
3189
a2c4f8e0 3190@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3 3191A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
861bb6c1
JL
3192address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3193the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3194frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
feca2ed3
JW
3195@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3196
e9a25f70 3197The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
4830ba1f 3198@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
e9a25f70 3199determine the return address of other frames.
a2c4f8e0 3200@end defmac
e9a25f70 3201
a2c4f8e0 3202@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
feca2ed3
JW
3203Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3204from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
a2c4f8e0 3205@end defmac
861bb6c1 3206
a2c4f8e0 3207@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
861bb6c1
JL
3208A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3209incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3210prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3211value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3212the stack.
3213
3214You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3215debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3216
2c849145 3217If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
aee96fe9 3218@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
a2c4f8e0 3219@end defmac
2c849145 3220
ed80cd68 3221@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
73774972 3222A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
5cd0f915
RS
3223number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3224must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3225be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3226
3227This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3228general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3229frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3230over time.
ed80cd68
RH
3231@end defmac
3232
282efe1c
RH
3233@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3234A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3235number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3236only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3237someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3238terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3239@end defmac
3240
e54c7471
EB
3241@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3242This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3243contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3244info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3245@smallexample
923158be 3246(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
e54c7471
EB
3247@end smallexample
3248and
3249@smallexample
923158be 3250(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
e54c7471
EB
3251@end smallexample
3252to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3253the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3254the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3255@end deftypefn
3256
a2c4f8e0 3257@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
861bb6c1
JL
3258A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3259from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3260frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3261the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3262previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3263
71038426
RH
3264You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3265debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3266@end defmac
71038426 3267
a2c4f8e0 3268@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
71038426
RH
3269A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3270from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
02f52e19 3271final value should coincide with that calculated by
71038426
RH
3272@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3273during virtual register instantiation.
3274
d17c29c3
PB
3275The default value for this macro is
3276@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2c849145 3277which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
208e52d9
JM
3278immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3279some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3280and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2c849145 3281
208e52d9 3282You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2c849145
JM
3283want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3284DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3285@end defmac
512b62fb 3286
f6672e8e
RH
3287@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3288If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3289in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
6fc0bb99 3290The final value should coincide with that calculated by
f6672e8e
RH
3291@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3292
3293Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
083cad55 3294via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
f6672e8e 3295variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
6416ae7f 3296defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
f6672e8e
RH
3297based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3298of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3299should be defined.
3300@end defmac
3301
35d177a2
AO
3302@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3303If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3304in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3305in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3306may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3307@end defmac
3308
7c16328b
RH
3309@node Exception Handling
3310@subsection Exception Handling Support
3311@cindex exception handling
3312
a2c4f8e0 3313@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
52a11cbf
RH
3314A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3315data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3316@var{N} registers are usable.
3317
3318The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3319handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3320should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3321but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33222 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3323
3324You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3325handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3326@end defmac
52a11cbf 3327
a2c4f8e0 3328@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
52a11cbf
RH
3329A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3330to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3331This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3332It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3333
02f52e19 3334Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
52a11cbf
RH
3335untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3336
34dc173c 3337Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
73774972
EC
3338by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3339this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3340stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3341this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
34dc173c 3342that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3343@end defmac
52a11cbf 3344
a2c4f8e0 3345@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
52a11cbf 3346A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
02f52e19 3347to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
52a11cbf
RH
3348return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3349
3350Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
02f52e19
AJ
3351return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3352address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
52a11cbf 3353the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
73774972
EC
3354frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3355been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
34dc173c 3356target call frame.
52a11cbf
RH
3357
3358Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3359address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3360the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3361
3362If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3363define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
a2c4f8e0 3364@end defmac
52a11cbf 3365
1e60c057
R
3366@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3367If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3368to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3369exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3370using it to return to the exception handler.
3371@end defmac
3372
a2c4f8e0 3373@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
2a1ee410
RH
3374This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3375handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3376that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3377and so may be read-only.
3378
aee96fe9
JM
3379@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3380@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2a1ee410
RH
3381The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3382as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3383
ebb48a4d 3384If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2a1ee410 3385represented directly.
a2c4f8e0 3386@end defmac
2a1ee410 3387
a2c4f8e0 3388@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2a1ee410
RH
3389This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3390to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3391Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3392be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3393
aee96fe9
JM
3394This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3395handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3396of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2a1ee410 3397to be emitted.
a2c4f8e0 3398@end defmac
2a1ee410 3399
8662eb14
AM
3400@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3401A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3402so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3403@end defmac
3404
3405@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
44082375 3406This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
7c16328b
RH
3407code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3408available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3409through signal frames.
3410
614e5a7d
BE
3411This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3412@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3413@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
7c16328b
RH
3414@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3415for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
614e5a7d
BE
3416the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3417save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3418evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3419the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
8207b189
FS
3420
3421For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3422@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
a2c4f8e0 3423@end defmac
861bb6c1 3424
3950dcdf
JJ
3425@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3426This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3427call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3428usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3429
3430This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3431@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3432@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3433for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3434@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3435be updated in @var{fs}.
3436@end defmac
3437
4746cf84
MA
3438@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3439A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3440info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3441linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3442@end defmac
3443
861bb6c1
JL
3444@node Stack Checking
3445@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3446
b38f3813
EB
3447GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3448stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3449three ways:
861bb6c1
JL
3450
3451@enumerate
3452@item
a3a15b4d 3453If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
b38f3813
EB
3454will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3455at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3456other special processing.
861bb6c1
JL
3457
3458@item
b38f3813
EB
3459If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3460@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3461that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3462static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3463in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3464stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3465approach below.
861bb6c1
JL
3466
3467@item
a3a15b4d 3468If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
861bb6c1
JL
3469``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3470@end enumerate
3471
b38f3813
EB
3472If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3473GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3474@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3475dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
861bb6c1 3476
a2c4f8e0 3477@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
861bb6c1 3478A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
02f52e19 3479machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
65a324b4 3480is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
b38f3813
EB
3481checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3482value of this macro is zero.
3483@end defmac
3484
3485@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3486A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3487in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3488like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3489approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
a2c4f8e0 3490@end defmac
861bb6c1 3491
d809253a
EB
3492@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3493An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3494instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3495define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3496the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3497of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 3498@end defmac
861bb6c1 3499
d809253a
EB
3500@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3501An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3502when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3503contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3504thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3505is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3506default value of this macro is zero.
3507@end defmac
3508
a2c4f8e0 3509@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
507d0069
EB
3510The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3511languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3512with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35138192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3514most machines.
a2c4f8e0 3515@end defmac
861bb6c1 3516
b38f3813
EB
3517The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3518nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3519in the opposite case.
3520
a2c4f8e0 3521@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3522The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
861bb6c1
JL
3523instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3524stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
a3a15b4d
JL
3525checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3526default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
861bb6c1 3527systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3528@end defmac
861bb6c1 3529
a2c4f8e0 3530@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3531GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
861bb6c1
JL
3532represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3533space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3534You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3535use the default of four words.
a2c4f8e0 3536@end defmac
861bb6c1 3537
a2c4f8e0 3538@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3539The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
861bb6c1 3540fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
630d3d5a 3541@option{-fstack-check}.
a3a15b4d 3542GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
861bb6c1 3543normally not need to override that default.
a2c4f8e0 3544@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3545
3546@need 2000
3547@node Frame Registers
3548@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3549
3550@c prevent bad page break with this line
3551This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3552
a2c4f8e0 3553@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3554The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3555fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3556the hardware determines which register this is.
a2c4f8e0 3557@end defmac
feca2ed3 3558
a2c4f8e0 3559@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3560The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3561access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3562hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3563choose any register you wish for this purpose.
a2c4f8e0 3564@end defmac
feca2ed3 3565
a2c4f8e0 3566@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3567On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3568offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3569allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3570between these two locations). On those machines, define
3571@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3572be used internally until the offset is known, and define
556e0f21 3573@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
feca2ed3
JW
3574used for the frame pointer.
3575
3576You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3577is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3578the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3579completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3580definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3581@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3582or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3583
3584Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3585@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
a2c4f8e0 3586@end defmac
feca2ed3 3587
a2c4f8e0 3588@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3589The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3590the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3591frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3592register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3593wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3594pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3595@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3596(@pxref{Elimination}).
a2c4f8e0 3597@end defmac
feca2ed3 3598
e3339d0f
JM
3599@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3600Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3601@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3602the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3603== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3604definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3605@end defmac
3606
3607@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3608Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3609@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3610same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3611ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3612definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3613@end defmac
3614
a2c4f8e0 3615@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3616The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3617access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3618machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3619pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3620to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3621@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3622
3623Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3624address from the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3625@end defmac
feca2ed3 3626
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3627@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3628@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3629Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3630register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3631function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3632number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3633these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
bd819a4a 3634not be defined.
feca2ed3
JW
3635
3636The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3637
3638If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2b4fa409 3639defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
a2c4f8e0 3640@end defmac
919543ab 3641
531ca746
RH
3642@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3643This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3644targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3645nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3646attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3647those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3648
3649The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
2b4fa409
RH
3650
3651If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3652provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3653Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3654from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3655will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3656@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3657@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3658@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3659The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3660@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3661to refer to those items.
531ca746
RH
3662@end deftypefn
3663
a2c4f8e0 3664@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3665This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3666saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3667DWARF2 exception handling.
3668
3669Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3670exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3671extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3672in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3673used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3674routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3675registers that are not call-saved.
3676
3677If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3678@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 3679@end defmac
919543ab 3680
a2c4f8e0 3681@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3682
3683This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3684for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3685
3686If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3687@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 3688@end defmac
919543ab 3689
a2c4f8e0 3690@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
41f3a930
AH
3691
3692Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3693is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
61aeb06f 3694Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
41f3a930
AH
3695column number to use instead.
3696
73774972 3697See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
a2c4f8e0 3698@end defmac
feca2ed3 3699
34c80057
AM
3700@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3701
3702Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3703used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
2dd76960 3704debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
34c80057
AM
3705should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3706@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3707
3708@end defmac
3709
3710@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3711
3712Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
2dd76960 3713that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
34c80057 3714should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
f676971a 3715.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
34c80057
AM
3716return @code{@var{regno}}.
3717
3718@end defmac
3719
feca2ed3
JW
3720@node Elimination
3721@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3722
3723@c prevent bad page break with this line
3724This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3725
b52b1749
AS
3726@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3727This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3728a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3729value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
feca2ed3 3730
b52b1749 3731This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
aea88c05
AS
3732according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3733constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3734to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3735Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3736pointer.
feca2ed3
JW
3737
3738In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3739without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3740automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
b52b1749 3741@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
bd819a4a 3742them.
feca2ed3
JW
3743
3744In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3745register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3746fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
aea88c05 3747
b52b1749
AS
3748Default return value is @code{false}.
3749@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3750
feca2ed3 3751@findex get_frame_size
a2c4f8e0 3752@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3753A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3754between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3755the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3756such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3757registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3758
3759If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3760need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
65a324b4 3761@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
feca2ed3 3762case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
a2c4f8e0 3763@end defmac
feca2ed3 3764
a2c4f8e0 3765@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
feca2ed3
JW
3766If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3767eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3768defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3769references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3770
3771The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3772of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3773
3774On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3775the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3776must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3777replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3778depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3779
3780In this case, you might specify:
3ab51846 3781@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3782#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3783@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3784 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3785 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3ab51846 3786@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3787
3788Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3789specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
a2c4f8e0 3790@end defmac
feca2ed3 3791
9ddb66ef 3792@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
7b5cbb57 3793This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
9ddb66ef
JR
3794try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3795@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3be639f7 3796is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
feca2ed3
JW
3797preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3798knows about.
3be639f7 3799
7b5cbb57
AS
3800Default return value is @code{true}.
3801@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3802
a2c4f8e0 3803@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3804This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3805specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3806registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3807defined.
a2c4f8e0 3808@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3809
3810@node Stack Arguments
3811@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3812@cindex arguments on stack
3813@cindex stack arguments
3814
3815The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3816on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3817control passing certain arguments in registers.
3818
9ddb66ef 3819@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
3820This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3821prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3822passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3823cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3824The default is to not promote prototypes.
3825@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3826
a2c4f8e0 3827@defmac PUSH_ARGS
767094dd 3828A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
f73ad30e
JH
3829outgoing arguments.
3830If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3831That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3832allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
aee96fe9 3833it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
a2c4f8e0 3834@end defmac
f73ad30e 3835
9d6bef95
JM
3836@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3837A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3838last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3839defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3840and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3841@end defmac
3842
a2c4f8e0 3843@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
feca2ed3
JW
3844A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3845stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
feca2ed3
JW
3846
3847On some machines, the definition
3848
3ab51846 3849@smallexample
feca2ed3 3850#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3ab51846 3851@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3852
3853@noindent
3854will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3855to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3856alignment. Then the definition should be
3857
3ab51846 3858@smallexample
feca2ed3 3859#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3ab51846 3860@end smallexample
4a6336ad
JR
3861
3862It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 3863@end defmac
feca2ed3 3864
feca2ed3 3865@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
a2c4f8e0 3866@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
767094dd 3867A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
feca2ed3
JW
3868will be computed and placed into the variable
3869@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3870onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3871increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3872
f73ad30e 3873Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
feca2ed3 3874is not proper.
a2c4f8e0 3875@end defmac
feca2ed3 3876
a2c4f8e0 3877@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3878Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3879allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3880registers.
3881
3882The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
ab87f8c8 3883arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
a3a15b4d 3884which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
5d059ed9
KT
3885The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3886of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3887
3888This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3889machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3890which.
a2c4f8e0 3891@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3892@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3893@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3894
81464b2c
KT
3895@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3896Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3897caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3898when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3899if the function called is a library function.
feca2ed3
JW
3900
3901If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3902whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3903@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
a2c4f8e0 3904@end defmac
feca2ed3 3905
a2c4f8e0 3906@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
feca2ed3
JW
3907Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3908stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3909@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3910@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3911
3912Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3913stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3914suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3915stack in its natural location.
a2c4f8e0 3916@end defmac
feca2ed3 3917
893d13d5 3918@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
079e7538
NF
3919This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3920a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3921and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
feca2ed3
JW
3922
3923@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3924the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3925@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
91d231cb 3926From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3927
3928@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3929describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3930@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3931From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3932arguments (if known).
3933
861bb6c1 3934When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
feca2ed3
JW
3935will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3936you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3937by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3938a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3939in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3940
893d13d5 3941@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
feca2ed3
JW
3942stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3943argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3944
8aeea6e6 3945On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3946of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
feca2ed3
JW
3947calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3948the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3949convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3950arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3951nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3952@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3953number of arguments.
079e7538 3954@end deftypefn
fa5322fa 3955
a2c4f8e0 3956@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
fa5322fa
AO
3957A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3958pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3959when compiling a function call.
3960
3961@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3962have been accumulated.
3963
3964On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3965that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3966that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3967call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3968appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 3969@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3970
3971@node Register Arguments
3972@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3973@cindex arguments in registers
3974@cindex registers arguments
3975
3976This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3977types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3978the stack.
3979
a2c4f8e0 3980@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
feca2ed3
JW
3981A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3982in a register, and which register.
3983
3984The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3985arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3986the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3987(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3988which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3989correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3719d27b
JO
3990@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3991occurred.
feca2ed3
JW
3992
3993The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3994hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3995argument on the stack.
3996
8aeea6e6 3997For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
feca2ed3
JW
3998pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3999
161d7b59 4000The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
feca2ed3 4001used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
ce376beb 4002@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
feca2ed3 4003@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
f797c10b
NC
4004describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4005@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4006register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4007register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4008second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4009the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
02f52e19 4010As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
c980b85b
NC
4011RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4012argument is also stored on the stack.
feca2ed3 4013
1cc5e432
GK
4014The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4015VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4016pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4017
feca2ed3 4018@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
5490d604 4019The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
feca2ed3
JW
4020where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4021nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4022by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4023
fe984136 4024@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
feca2ed3 4025@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
fe984136 4026You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
feca2ed3
JW
4027in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4028type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
df2a54e9 4029is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
feca2ed3
JW
4030argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4031defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4032a register.
a2c4f8e0 4033@end defmac
feca2ed3 4034
9ddb66ef 4035@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
fe984136
RH
4036This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4037solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
d9a4ee00
JL
4038definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4039documentation.
fe984136 4040@end deftypefn
d9a4ee00 4041
a2c4f8e0 4042@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
feca2ed3
JW
4043Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4044that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4045necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4046argument.
4047
4048For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4049the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4050be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4051where the arguments will arrive.
4052
4053If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
bd819a4a 4054serves both purposes.
a2c4f8e0 4055@end defmac
feca2ed3 4056
78a52f11
RH
4057@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4058This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4059argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
feca2ed3
JW
4060arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4061pushed on the stack.
4062
4063On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4064registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
78a52f11 4065first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
feca2ed3
JW
4066on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4067structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4068in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
78a52f11 4069compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
feca2ed3
JW
4070
4071@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4072register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4073@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
78a52f11 4074@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4075
ec9f85e5 4076@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f676971a 4077This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
8cd5a4e0 4078position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
f676971a 4079predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
8cd5a4e0
RH
4080passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4081
4082If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
feca2ed3
JW
4083pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4084The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4085to that type.
8cd5a4e0 4086@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4087
9ddb66ef 4088@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
6cdd5672
RH
4089The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4090known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4091function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4092by the caller.
4093
a1c496cb 4094For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
6cdd5672
RH
4095determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4096not be generated.
4097
4098The default version of this hook always returns false.
4099@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4100
a2c4f8e0 4101@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
feca2ed3
JW
4102A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4103@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4104the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4105argument so far.
4106
4107There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4108arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4109variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4110arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4111@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4112should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 4113@end defmac
feca2ed3 4114
7c800926
KT
4115@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4116If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4117function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4118created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4119reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4120If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4121@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4122@end defmac
4123
0f6937fe 4124@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
a2c4f8e0
ZW
4125A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4126@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4127variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4128is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4129the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4130For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4131declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4132@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
0f6937fe
AM
4133being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4134arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4135parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
78466c0e 4136@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
feca2ed3
JW
4137
4138When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4139@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4140contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4141an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4142macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4143never both of them at once.
a2c4f8e0 4144@end defmac
feca2ed3 4145
a2c4f8e0 4146@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
97fc4caf
AO
4147Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4148it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4149@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4150is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41510)} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 4152@end defmac
97fc4caf 4153
a2c4f8e0 4154@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
feca2ed3
JW
4155Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4156finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4157undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4158
4159The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
161d7b59 4160with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
feca2ed3
JW
4161argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4162@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4163@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4164@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4165@end defmac
feca2ed3 4166
a2c4f8e0 4167@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
feca2ed3
JW
4168A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4169@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4170values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4171Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
bd819a4a 4172the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
feca2ed3
JW
4173
4174This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4175on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4176used for arguments without any special help.
a2c4f8e0 4177@end defmac
feca2ed3 4178
099590dc
MM
4179@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4180If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4181offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4182which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4183slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4184top.
4185@end defmac
4186
a2c4f8e0 4187@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
4188If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4189to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4190@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4191@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4192
4193The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
c2ed6cf8
NF
4194multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4195control it.
feca2ed3
JW
4196
4197This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4198For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4199big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4200constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 4201@end defmac
feca2ed3 4202
a2c4f8e0 4203@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
02f52e19
AJ
4204If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4205implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
5e4f6244
CP
4206next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4207controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4208arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
a2c4f8e0 4209@end defmac
5e4f6244 4210
6e985040
AM
4211@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4212Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4213memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4214macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4215machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4216@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4217registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4218a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4219required.
4220@end defmac
4221
c2ed6cf8
NF
4222@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4223This hook returns the the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4224with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4225@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4226@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4227
a2c4f8e0 4228@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4229A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4230register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4231@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4232the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4233used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4234stack.
a2c4f8e0 4235@end defmac
bb1b857a 4236
9ddb66ef 4237@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
42ba5130
RH
4238This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4239as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4240arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4241to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4242AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4243registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4244point register.
4245
4246The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4247false.
4248@end deftypefn
ded9bf77 4249
d3da4d14
RH
4250@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4251This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4252The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4253@end deftypefn
4254
07a5b2bc 4255@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
d4048208
KT
4256This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4257to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4258variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4259to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
d4048208 4260variable.
07a5b2bc 4261The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
d4048208
KT
4262this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4263internal type.
4264If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4265Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4266macro to iterate through all types.
4267@end deftypefn
4268
35cbb299
KT
4269@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4270This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4271@var{fndecl}.
4272The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4273@end deftypefn
4274
4275@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4276This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4277type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4278@code{NULL_TREE}.
4279@end deftypefn
4280
9ddb66ef 4281@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
23a60a04
JM
4282This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4283@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4284arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4285@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
23a60a04
JM
4286@end deftypefn
4287
e09ec166
EC
4288@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4289Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4290with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4291hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4292@end deftypefn
4293
6dd53648
RH
4294@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4295Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4296insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4297considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4298must work.
4299
4300The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4301required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4302Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4303code in @file{optabs.c}.
4304@end deftypefn
4305
f676971a
EC
4306@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4307Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4308insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4309must have move patterns for this mode.
4310@end deftypefn
4311
42db504c
SB
4312@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4313Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4314small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4315@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4316in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4317In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4318for any mode.
4319
4320On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4321insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4322to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4323if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4324insn.
4325
4326Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4327in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4328the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4329classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4330registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4331registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4332SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4333strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4334machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4335
4336The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4337safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4338unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4339that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4340to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4341of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4342@end deftypefn
4343
feca2ed3
JW
4344@node Scalar Return
4345@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4346@cindex return values in registers
4347@cindex values, returned by functions
4348@cindex scalars, returned as values
4349
4350This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4351values---values that can fit in registers.
4352
9ddb66ef 4353@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
1b03c58a
RG
4354
4355Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4356returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
e4ae5e77 4357representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
1b03c58a
RG
4358representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4359function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4360compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4361Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4362a function returns a value.
4363
4364On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4365(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4366place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4367@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4368The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4369multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
576c9028
KH
4370@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4371location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4372the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4373that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4374port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4375@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
1b03c58a
RG
4376
4377If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4378the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4379@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
feca2ed3
JW
4380
4381If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4382node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4383pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4384convention for specific functions when all their calls are
bd819a4a 4385known.
feca2ed3 4386
1b03c58a
RG
4387Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4388which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4389the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4390different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4391
4392@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4393aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
cea28603 4394@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
1b03c58a
RG
4395@end deftypefn
4396
4397@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4398This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4399a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4400@end defmac
feca2ed3 4401
a2c4f8e0 4402@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3 4403A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
dc672951 4404function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3
JW
4405
4406Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4407support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4408specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4409compiled.
a2c4f8e0 4410@end defmac
feca2ed3 4411
38f8b050 4412@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
390b17c2
RE
4413Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4414function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4415
4416The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4417library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4418representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4419
4420If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4421@end deftypefn
4422
a2c4f8e0 4423@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4424A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4425register in which the values of called function may come back.
4426
4427A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4428second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4429recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4430suffices:
4431
3ab51846 4432@smallexample
feca2ed3 4433#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3ab51846 4434@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
4435
4436If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4437function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4438should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
82f81f18
AS
4439
4440This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4441for a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4442@end defmac
feca2ed3 4443
82f81f18
AS
4444@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4445A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4446register in which the values of called function may come back.
4447
4448A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4449second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4450recognized by this target hook.
4451
4452If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4453function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4454should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4455
4456If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4457@end deftypefn
4458
a2c4f8e0 4459@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
4460Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4461need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4462saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
a2c4f8e0 4463@end defmac
feca2ed3 4464
9ddb66ef 4465@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
c988af2b
RS
4466This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4467at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4468padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4469is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4470
1b03c58a
RG
4471Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4472be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4473or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44744-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4475@code{SImode} rtx.
c988af2b
RS
4476@end deftypefn
4477
feca2ed3
JW
4478@node Aggregate Return
4479@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4480@cindex aggregates as return values
4481@cindex large return values
4482@cindex returning aggregate values
4483@cindex structure value address
4484
4485When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
1b03c58a
RG
4486cases), the value is not returned according to
4487@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4488caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4489should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4490address}.
feca2ed3
JW
4491
4492This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4493memory.
4494
9ddb66ef 4495@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
4496This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4497function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4498Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4499will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4500libcalls.
feca2ed3
JW
4501
4502Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
61f71b34 4503by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
feca2ed3 4504takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
61f71b34 4505possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
feca2ed3
JW
4506definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4507values, and 0 otherwise.
4508
61f71b34 4509Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
feca2ed3
JW
4510be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4511to indicate this.
61f71b34 4512@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4513
a2c4f8e0 4514@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4515Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4516in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
161d7b59 4517only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
feca2ed3 4518If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
d624465f
KH
4519and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4520target hook.
feca2ed3
JW
4521
4522If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
a2c4f8e0 4523@end defmac
feca2ed3 4524
61f71b34
DD
4525@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4526This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4527address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4528passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
1f6acb82
KH
4529be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4530hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4531argument.
feca2ed3 4532
feca2ed3
JW
4533On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4534is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4535caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4536be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
2225b57c
CD
4537@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4538the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
61f71b34 4539the caller.
feca2ed3 4540
917f1b7e 4541If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
2225b57c
CD
4542stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4543@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
64ee9490 4544structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
2225b57c 4545to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
61f71b34 4546@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4547
a2c4f8e0 4548@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4549Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4550for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4551the address of a static variable containing the value.
4552
4553Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4554pass an address to the subroutine.
4555
630d3d5a
JM
4556This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4557nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
a2c4f8e0 4558@end defmac
feca2ed3 4559
ffa88471
SE
4560@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4561This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4562@end deftypefn
4563
4564@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4565This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4566@end deftypefn
4567
feca2ed3
JW
4568@node Caller Saves
4569@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4570
a3a15b4d 4571If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
feca2ed3
JW
4572makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4573must live across calls.
4574
a2c4f8e0 4575@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
feca2ed3
JW
4576A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4577a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4578restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4579this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4580
4581If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4582machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
a2c4f8e0 4583@end defmac
8d5c8167 4584
a2c4f8e0 4585@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
8d5c8167
JL
4586A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4587of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4588@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4589returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4590will select the smallest suitable mode.
a2c4f8e0 4591@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4592
4593@node Function Entry
4594@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4595@cindex function entry and exit
4596@cindex prologue
4597@cindex epilogue
4598
4599This section describes the macros that output function entry
4600(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4601
08c148a8
NB
4602@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4603If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
feca2ed3
JW
4604function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4605initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4606saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4607local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4608stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4609
4610The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4611macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4612
4613@findex regs_ever_live
4614To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4615@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4616@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4617prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
08c148a8 4618call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
feca2ed3
JW
4619@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4620
4621On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4622not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4623they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4624appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4625registers are used in the function.
4626
4627@findex frame_pointer_needed
4628On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4629function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4630pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4631frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4632@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4633time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4634
4635The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4636required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4637listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4638order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4639stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4640the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4641for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4642compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4643or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4644need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
08c148a8
NB
4645@end deftypefn
4646
17b53c33
NB
4647@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4648If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4649prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4650emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4651emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4652@end deftypefn
4653
4654@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4655If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4656epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4657emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4658emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4659@end deftypefn
4660
08c148a8
NB
4661@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4662If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4663function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4664registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4665called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4666same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4667registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4668@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4669
4670On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4671of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4672instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4673@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4674
4675Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4676@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4677switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4678define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4679target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4680condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4681
4682On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4683function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4684two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4685is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4686@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4687a function that needs a frame pointer.
4688
4689Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4690@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4691The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4692function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4693
4694On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4695others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4696given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4697number of arguments.
4698
4699@findex current_function_pops_args
4700Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4701functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
72392b81
JR
4702needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4703function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4704@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
08c148a8
NB
4705@end deftypefn
4706
feca2ed3
JW
4707@itemize @bullet
4708@item
4709@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4710A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4711uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4712stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4713if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4714arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4715yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4716region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4717registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
6c535c69 4718features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
feca2ed3
JW
4719
4720@item
4721An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4722The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4723the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4724machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4725in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4726a save area.
4727
4728@item
4729A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4730boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4731this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4732save area closer to the top of the stack.
4733
4734@item
4735@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4736Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4737@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4738argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4739@end itemize
4740
a2c4f8e0 4741@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
feca2ed3
JW
4742Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4743instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4744pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
9d05bbce
KH
4745adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4746default is 0.
feca2ed3
JW
4747
4748Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4749frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4750stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4751compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
a2c4f8e0 4752@end defmac
feca2ed3 4753
a2c4f8e0 4754@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
8760eaae 4755Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
feca2ed3 4756used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
86c33cd0 4757pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
a2c4f8e0 4758@end defmac
feca2ed3 4759
a2c4f8e0 4760@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
15b5aef3
RH
4761Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4762used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4763on entry to an exception edge.
a2c4f8e0 4764@end defmac
15b5aef3 4765
a2c4f8e0 4766@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4767Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4768instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4769definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4770representing the number of delay slots there.
a2c4f8e0 4771@end defmac
feca2ed3 4772
a2c4f8e0 4773@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
feca2ed3
JW
4774A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4775slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4776
4777The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4778being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4779eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4780of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4781If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4782may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4783(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4784slot.
4785
4786@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4787@findex final_scan_insn
4788The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4789list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4790@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4791delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
08c148a8
NB
4792@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4793outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4794@code{final_scan_insn}.
feca2ed3
JW
4795
4796You need not define this macro if you did not define
4797@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
a2c4f8e0 4798@end defmac
feca2ed3 4799
65e71cd6 4800@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
483ab821 4801A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
feca2ed3
JW
4802function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4803inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4804adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4805the real function.
4806
4807First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4808contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4809contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4810in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
e979f9e8 4811e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
feca2ed3
JW
4812all other incoming arguments.
4813
65e71cd6
EB
4814Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4815made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4816adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4817
4818@smallexample
4819p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4820@end smallexample
4821
4822After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
feca2ed3
JW
4823@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4824not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4825return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4826
4827The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4828the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
08c148a8
NB
4829of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4830and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
feca2ed3
JW
4831
4832The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4833have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4834some targets, but probably not.
4835
861bb6c1 4836If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
c771326b 4837front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
861bb6c1
JL
4838@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4839not support varargs.
483ab821
MM
4840@end deftypefn
4841
9ddb66ef 4842@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
65e71cd6
EB
4843A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4844to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4845arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4846generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4847previously exposed.
483ab821 4848@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4849
4850@node Profiling
4851@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4852@cindex profiling, code generation
4853
4854These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4855
a2c4f8e0 4856@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
feca2ed3
JW
4857A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4858assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
feca2ed3
JW
4859
4860@findex mcount
980e2067 4861The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
161d7b59 4862your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
980e2067
JL
4863compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4864compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4865
4866Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4867variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4868@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4869the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
a2c4f8e0 4870@end defmac
980e2067 4871
a2c4f8e0 4872@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
411707f4
CC
4873A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4874code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4875not support profiling.
a2c4f8e0 4876@end defmac
411707f4 4877
a2c4f8e0 4878@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
8b65a354
JZ
4879Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4880@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4881allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4882implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4883@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
a2c4f8e0 4884@end defmac
feca2ed3 4885
a2c4f8e0 4886@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4887Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4888the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
a2c4f8e0 4889@end defmac
feca2ed3 4890
91d231cb
JM
4891@node Tail Calls
4892@subsection Permitting tail calls
4893@cindex tail calls
b36f4ed3 4894
4977bab6
ZW
4895@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4896True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4897call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4898or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4cb1433c
RH
4899
4900It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4901tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4977bab6 4902during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
02f52e19 4903as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4977bab6
ZW
4904``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4905may vary greatly between different architectures.
4906@end deftypefn
4cb1433c 4907
9ddb66ef 4908@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
912f2dac
DB
4909Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4910function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4911cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4912registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4913TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4914FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4915@end deftypefn
4916
7d69de61
RH
4917@node Stack Smashing Protection
4918@subsection Stack smashing protection
4919@cindex stack smashing protection
4920
4921@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4922This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
083cad55 4923for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
7d69de61
RH
4924runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4925that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4926variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4927
4928The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4929@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4930@end deftypefn
4931
4932@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4933This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4934stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4935involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4936
4937The default version of this hook invokes a function called
083cad55 4938@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
7d69de61
RH
4939normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4940@end deftypefn
4941
d5fabb58
JM
4942@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4943Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
7458026b
ILT
4944@end deftypefn
4945
feca2ed3
JW
4946@node Varargs
4947@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4948@cindex varargs implementation
4949
aee96fe9
JM
4950GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4951@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
feca2ed3
JW
4952on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4953varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4954conditionals to include it.
4955
aee96fe9 4956ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
feca2ed3
JW
4957the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4958implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5490d604 4959to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
feca2ed3
JW
4960@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4961supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4962
4963However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4964the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4965below.
4966
a2c4f8e0 4967@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
feca2ed3 4968Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5490d604 4969that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
feca2ed3 4970versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
c2379679 4971you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
feca2ed3
JW
4972
4973On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
f61c92c3
KH
4974control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4975other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4976found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
feca2ed3
JW
4977
4978Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4979beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4980@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4981This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4982to use them for its own purposes.
4983@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4984@c 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4985@end defmac
feca2ed3 4986
a2c4f8e0 4987@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4988This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
767094dd 4989argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
feca2ed3
JW
4990returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4991argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4992fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4993verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4994of the current function.
a2c4f8e0 4995@end defmac
feca2ed3 4996
a2c4f8e0 4997@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
feca2ed3
JW
4998Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4999passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5000has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5001specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5002with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5003
5004@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5005considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5006kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5007
5008The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5009interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
a2c4f8e0 5010@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5011
5012These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5013
61f71b34
DD
5014@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5015If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5016@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5017beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5018return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5019to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5020@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5021
61f71b34
DD
5022@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5023This target hook offers an alternative to using
5024@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5025@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5026register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5027have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5028use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5029pass all their arguments on the stack.
feca2ed3 5030
61f71b34 5031The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
8760eaae 5032structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
feca2ed3
JW
5033named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5034last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5035
61f71b34
DD
5036The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5037argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5038store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5039variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5040store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5041frame.
feca2ed3
JW
5042
5043Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5044compile time without knowing their data types,
61f71b34
DD
5045@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5046have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5047for all data types.
feca2ed3
JW
5048
5049If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5050arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5051happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
61f71b34 5052end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
feca2ed3 5053not generate any instructions in this case.
61f71b34 5054@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5055
61f71b34
DD
5056@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
5057Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
e5e809f4 5058argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
feca2ed3 5059
61f71b34
DD
5060This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5061is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5062@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5063arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5b4ef0b1 5064but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
61f71b34
DD
5065then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5066except the last are treated as named.
e5e809f4 5067
9ddb66ef 5068You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
61f71b34 5069@end deftypefn
9ab70a9b 5070
9ddb66ef 5071@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
9ab70a9b 5072If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
61f71b34
DD
5073@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5074@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5075defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
c2379679 5076@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
61f71b34
DD
5077Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5078@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5079
5080@node Trampolines
5081@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5082@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5083@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5084
5085A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5086when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5087the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
a3a15b4d 5088tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
feca2ed3
JW
5089trampoline.
5090
5091The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5092address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5093the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5094two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5095exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5096machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5097two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5098operands.
5099
5100The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5101parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5102immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5103simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5104proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5105may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5106separately.
5107
531ca746
RH
5108@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5109This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5110on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5111the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5112label---the label is taken care of automatically.
feca2ed3 5113
531ca746
RH
5114If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5115for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
feca2ed3
JW
5116code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5117to generate it on the spot.
531ca746 5118@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5119
a2c4f8e0 5120@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
d6b5193b
RS
5121Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5122(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
a2c4f8e0 5123@end defmac
feca2ed3 5124
a2c4f8e0 5125@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
feca2ed3 5126A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
a2c4f8e0 5127@end defmac
feca2ed3 5128
a2c4f8e0 5129@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
5130Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5131
531ca746 5132If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
feca2ed3 5133is used for aligning trampolines.
a2c4f8e0 5134@end defmac
feca2ed3 5135
531ca746
RH
5136@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5137This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5138@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5139is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
feca2ed3
JW
5140RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5141when it is called.
5142
531ca746
RH
5143If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5144first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5145from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5146Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5147trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5148to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
b33493e3 5149
531ca746
RH
5150If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5151enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5152initializing the trampoline proper.
5153@end deftypefn
5154
5155@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5156This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5157the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5158memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5159the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5160address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5161be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5162If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5163@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5164
5165Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5166separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5167fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5168jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5169
5170Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5171the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5172make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5173subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5174latter makes initialization faster.
5175
5176To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
f691dc3b 5177the following macro.
feca2ed3 5178
a2c4f8e0 5179@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
feca2ed3 5180If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
f691dc3b
AJ
5181cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5182typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5183@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
a2c4f8e0 5184@end defmac
feca2ed3 5185
e7a742ec
EB
5186The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5187before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5188the following macro.
5189
5190@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5191Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5192code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
431ae0bf 5193file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
e7a742ec
EB
5194named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5195emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
531ca746 5196@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
e7a742ec
EB
5197@end defmac
5198
feca2ed3
JW
5199To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5200you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5201cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5202beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5203its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5204
a2c4f8e0 5205@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
feca2ed3
JW
5206Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5207work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
161d7b59 5208which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
feca2ed3
JW
5209@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5210
5211If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5212C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5213special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5214statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5215global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5216special assembler code.
a2c4f8e0 5217@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5218
5219@node Library Calls
5220@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5221@cindex library subroutine names
5222@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5223
5224@c prevent bad page break with this line
5225Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5226
a2c4f8e0 5227@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
d8088c6f
BS
5228This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5229expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
2dd76960 5230provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
d8088c6f 5231are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
a2c4f8e0 5232@end defmac
d8088c6f 5233
c15c90bb 5234@findex set_optab_libfunc
914d25dc 5235@findex init_one_libfunc
c15c90bb
ZW
5236@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5237This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5238existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5239@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5240@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5241library routines.
feca2ed3 5242
c15c90bb
ZW
5243The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5244@end deftypefn
c5c60e15 5245
9c917669 5246@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
c15c90bb
ZW
5247This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5248implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5249mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5250return a tristate.
5251
5252GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5253comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5254don't need to define this macro.
5255@end defmac
5256
b3f8d95d
MM
5257@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5258This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5259functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5260operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5261and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
38b974a6 5262If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
78466c0e 5263@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
b3f8d95d
MM
5264in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5265@end defmac
5266
c15c90bb
ZW
5267@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5268@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5269@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5270@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5271@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5272Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
73774972 5273library to provide floating point emulation.
c15c90bb
ZW
5274
5275In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5276@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5277else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5278in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5279architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5280an example.
5281
5282If this macro is defined, the
5283@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5284false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
a2c4f8e0 5285@end defmac
c5c60e15 5286
feca2ed3 5287@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5288@findex matherr
5289@defmac TARGET_EDOM
feca2ed3 5290The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
a3a15b4d 5291expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
feca2ed3
JW
5292deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5293@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5294system.
5295
5296If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5297domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5298error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5299there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5300that @code{matherr} is used normally.
a2c4f8e0 5301@end defmac
feca2ed3 5302
feca2ed3 5303@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5304@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
feca2ed3
JW
5305Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5306refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5307@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5308macro, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 5309@end defmac
feca2ed3 5310
272f51a3 5311@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5312@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
272f51a3 5313When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
3bcf1b13 5314@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5472de36
SE
5315default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5316functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5317systems that do support the C99 runtime.
a2c4f8e0 5318@end defmac
272f51a3 5319
006339cd
RG
5320@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5321@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5322When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5323and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5324default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5325@smallexample
5326void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5327void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5328void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5329@end smallexample
5330@end defmac
5331
a2c4f8e0 5332@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
2147b154 5333Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
feca2ed3
JW
5334the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5335involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5336at once to the method-lookup library function.
5337
5338The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5339to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
a2c4f8e0 5340@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5341
5342@node Addressing Modes
5343@section Addressing Modes
5344@cindex addressing modes
5345
5346@c prevent bad page break with this line
5347This is about addressing modes.
5348
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5349@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5350@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5351@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5352@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
df2a54e9 5353A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
7a6bd5ae 5354pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
a2c4f8e0 5355@end defmac
feca2ed3 5356
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5357@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5358@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
df2a54e9 5359A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae
JL
5360post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5361the size of the memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 5362@end defmac
864bcaa7 5363
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5364@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5365@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
df2a54e9 5366A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae 5367post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
a2c4f8e0 5368@end defmac
864bcaa7 5369
a2c4f8e0 5370@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3 5371A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
65a324b4
NC
5372is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5373@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5374is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5375constant addresses are supported.
a2c4f8e0 5376@end defmac
feca2ed3 5377
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5378@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5379@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5380accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5381known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5382expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5383@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5384@end defmac
feca2ed3 5385
a2c4f8e0 5386@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
feca2ed3
JW
5387A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5388memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
c6c3dba9 5389the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
feca2ed3 5390accept.
a2c4f8e0 5391@end defmac
feca2ed3 5392
914d25dc 5393@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
c6c3dba9
PB
5394A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5395address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3 5396
c6c3dba9 5397Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
914d25dc 5398non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
c6c3dba9 5399desired by the caller.
feca2ed3 5400
c6c3dba9
PB
5401The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5402that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5403considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5404kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5405must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5406up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5407register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5408if the array holds @code{-1}.
feca2ed3
JW
5409
5410The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5411accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5412register is required.
5413
feca2ed3
JW
5414Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5415and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5416constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5417specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5418recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5419
5420Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5421sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5422@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5423naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5424be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5425
fb49053f 5426@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
feca2ed3
JW
5427On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5428the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
fb49053f
RH
5429target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5430into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
feca2ed3
JW
5431@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5432@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5433Format}.
c6c3dba9
PB
5434
5435@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5436Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5437this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5438has this syntax:
5439
5440@example
5441#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5442@end example
5443
5444@noindent
5445and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5446address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5447
5448@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5449Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5450macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5451@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5452that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5453
c6c3dba9
PB
5454Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5455files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5456@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5457
a4edaf83
AK
5458@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5459A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5460character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5461letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
c6c3dba9 5462@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
a4edaf83
AK
5463support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5464semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5465preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5466@code{'m'} constraint.
5467@end defmac
5468
a2c4f8e0 5469@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
a9e6fc5a
RS
5470A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5471or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
53451050
RS
5472can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5473@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
b949ea8b
JW
5474
5475It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5476that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5477
5478The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
161d7b59 5479a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 5480@end defmac
b949ea8b 5481
506d7b68
PB
5482@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5483This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5484operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5485address.
feca2ed3
JW
5486
5487@findex break_out_memory_refs
5488@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5489and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5490@var{x}.
5491
506d7b68 5492The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
feca2ed3 5493@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
506d7b68 5494should return the new @var{x}.
feca2ed3 5495
506d7b68
PB
5496It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5497The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5498is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5499a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5500strategy can generate better code.
5501@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5502
a2c4f8e0 5503@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
a9a2595b
JR
5504A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5505that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5506@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5507It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
02f52e19 5508performance reasons.
a9a2595b
JR
5509
5510For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5511reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5512registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5513processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5514needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
aee96fe9 5515@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
a9a2595b
JR
5516generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5517be shared.
5518
39bdfaa0
RH
5519@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5520to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5521and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5522of reload internals.
a9a2595b 5523
5f0c590d
JL
5524@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5525previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5526then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5527
a9a2595b 5528@findex push_reload
39bdfaa0
RH
5529The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5530need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5531suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
a9a2595b 5532
39bdfaa0 5533The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
a9a2595b
JR
5534@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5535should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5536This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5537@code{push_reload}.
5538
39bdfaa0
RH
5539@findex strict_memory_address_p
5540The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5541the address has become legitimate.
5542
a9a2595b
JR
5543@findex copy_rtx
5544If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
ab873839 5545this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
a9a2595b 5546single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
c771326b 5547top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
a9a2595b
JR
5548It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5549address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
a2c4f8e0 5550@end defmac
a9a2595b 5551
cbda7dc6
AS
5552@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5553This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5554different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5555reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5556but not others.
5557
5558Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5559effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5560of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5561addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5562
5563You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5564
5565The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5566@end deftypefn
5567
a2c4f8e0 5568@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
feca2ed3
JW
5569A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5570@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5571different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5572reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5573but not others.
5574
5575Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5576effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5577of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5578addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5579
5580You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
cbda7dc6
AS
5581
5582These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5583@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
a2c4f8e0 5584@end defmac
feca2ed3 5585
a2c4f8e0 5586@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
5587A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5588an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5589@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5590@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
bd819a4a 5591anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
a2c4f8e0 5592@end defmac
feca2ed3 5593
73f8783a
RS
5594@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5595This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5596@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5597macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5598references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5599addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5600the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5601into their original form.
5602@end deftypefn
5603
d3da4d14
RH
5604@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (rtx @var{x})
5605This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5606should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5607this hook returns false.
5608
5609The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5610deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5611from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5612holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5613of TLS symbols for various targets.
5614@end deftypefn
5615
b6fd8800 5616@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885
RS
5617This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5618be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5619of @var{x}.
5620
5621The default version returns false for all constants.
5622@end deftypefn
5623
5eb7ce91 5624@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
6b889d89 5625This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
ac10986f 5626the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5eb7ce91 5627@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
ac10986f
UB
5628when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5629@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5630of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5631function are valid.
6b889d89
UB
5632@end deftypefn
5633
d16b59fa
DN
5634@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5635This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5636address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
083cad55 5637used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
d16b59fa
DN
5638@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5639
ab873839 5640The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
d16b59fa
DN
5641@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5642the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5643@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5644two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5645@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5646the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5647from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
083cad55
EC
5648@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5649@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
d16b59fa
DN
5650@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5651
5652If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5653to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5654use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5655@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
083cad55 5656should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
d16b59fa
DN
5657described above.
5658If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5659the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
8ad1dde7 5660log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
d16b59fa
DN
5661@end deftypefn
5662
89d67cca
DN
5663@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN (tree @var{x})
5664This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5665widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5666
5667If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5668@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5669widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
021efafc 5670preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
89d67cca
DN
5671@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5672@end deftypefn
5673
5674@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD (tree @var{x})
5675This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5676widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5677
5678If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5679@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5680widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
021efafc 5681preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
89d67cca
DN
5682@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5683@end deftypefn
5684
720f5239 5685@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
35e1a5e7 5686Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5687For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5688misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
a934eb2d
JR
5689@end deftypefn
5690
5691@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5692Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5693@end deftypefn
5694
5695@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{mask_element_type})
5696Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5697@end deftypefn
5698
5699@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK (tree @var{vec_type}, tree @var{mask})
5700Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5701@end deftypefn
5702
88dd7150 5703@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
f57d17f1 5704This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
88dd7150 5705input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
a934eb2d
JR
5706The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5707specifies how the conversion is to be applied
f57d17f1
TM
5708(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5709
5710If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5711@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5712conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5713@end deftypefn
5714
62f7fd21
MM
5715@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5716This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5717vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5718@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5719The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5720return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5721@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
2505a3f2
RG
5722@end deftypefn
5723
38f8b050 5724@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
0601d0cf
RE
5725This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5726store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5727parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5728the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5729parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5730@end deftypefn
5731
cc4b5170
RG
5732@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5733This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5734mode @var{mode}. The default is
5735equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5736transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5737@end deftypefn
5738
767f865f
RG
5739@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5740This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5741after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5742mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5743The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5744@end deftypefn
5745
aacd3885
RS
5746@node Anchored Addresses
5747@section Anchored Addresses
5748@cindex anchored addresses
5749@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5750
5751GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5752For example, if we have:
5753
5754@smallexample
5755static int a, b, c;
5756int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5757@end smallexample
5758
5759the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5760addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5761it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5762the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5763be something like:
5764
5765@smallexample
5766int foo (void)
5767@{
5768 register int *xr = &x;
5769 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5770@}
5771@end smallexample
5772
5773(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5774``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5775
5776The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5777in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5778section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5779or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5780
9e3be889 5781@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5782The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5783On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5784applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5785for every mode. The default value is 0.
9e3be889 5786@end deftypevr
aacd3885 5787
9e3be889 5788@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5789Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5790offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5791value is 0.
9e3be889 5792@end deftypevr
aacd3885
RS
5793
5794@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5795Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5796@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5797The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5798of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5799
5800If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5801it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5802If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5803is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5804@end deftypefn
5805
b6fd8800 5806@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885 5807Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3fa9c136 5808@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
aacd3885
RS
5809@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5810
5811The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5812intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5813or target-specific sections.
5814@end deftypefn
5815
feca2ed3
JW
5816@node Condition Code
5817@section Condition Code Status
5818@cindex condition code status
5819
f90b7a5a
PB
5820The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5821two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5822
5823The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5824(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5825clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5826register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5827architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5828most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5829most RISC machines.
5830
5831The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5832the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5833insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5834optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5835is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5836three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5837scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5838separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5839
5840For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5841represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5842condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5843condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5844or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5845Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5846that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5847
5848Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5849specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5850interested in most macros in this section.
5851
5852@menu
5853* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5854* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5855* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
f90b7a5a
PB
5856@end menu
5857
5858@node CC0 Condition Codes
5859@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5860@findex cc0
feca2ed3
JW
5861
5862@findex cc_status
5863The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5864describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5865the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5866variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5867currently based, and several standard flags.
5868
5869Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5870description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5871information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5872
a2c4f8e0 5873@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
feca2ed3
JW
5874C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5875component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5876
5877This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5878@end defmac
feca2ed3 5879
a2c4f8e0 5880@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
feca2ed3
JW
5881A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5882The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5883the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5884define this macro to initialize it.
5885
5886This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5887@end defmac
feca2ed3 5888
a2c4f8e0 5889@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
5890A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5891appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5892this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5893code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5894set @code{(cc0)}.
5895
5896This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5897
5898If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5899other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5900invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5901reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5902registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5903@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5904insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5905based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5906value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5907this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5908@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5909@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5910condition code value.
5911
5912The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5913with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5914@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5915constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5916insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5917@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5918@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5919
5920A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5921that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5922@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5923two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
a2c4f8e0 5924@end defmac
feca2ed3 5925
f90b7a5a
PB
5926@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5927@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5928@findex CCmode
5929@findex MODE_CC
5930
a2c4f8e0 5931@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
f90b7a5a
PB
5932On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5933than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5934code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5935when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5936bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5937branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5938this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5939record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5940also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5941unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5942
5943If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5944@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5945a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5946have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5947by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5948be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5949the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5950
5951@smallexample
5952(define_insn ""
5953 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5954 (compare:CC_NOOV
5955 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5956 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5957 (const_int 0)))]
5958 ""
5959 "@dots{}")
5960@end smallexample
5961
5962@noindent
5963together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5964for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
feca2ed3
JW
5965
5966@smallexample
5967#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5968 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5969 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5970 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5971 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5972 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5973@end smallexample
5974
f90b7a5a
PB
5975Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5976were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5977this section.
5978
94134f42
ZW
5979You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5980in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
a2c4f8e0 5981@end defmac
feca2ed3 5982
a2c4f8e0 5983@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
8760eaae 5984On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
feca2ed3
JW
5985convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5986does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5987comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5988
5989On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5990required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5991and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5992comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5993@var{op1} as required.
5994
a3a15b4d 5995GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
5996valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5997@file{md} file.
5998
5999You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6000code or operands.
a2c4f8e0 6001@end defmac
feca2ed3 6002
a2c4f8e0 6003@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
6004A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6005comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6006can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6007then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6008
6009You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6010floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
981f6289 6011For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
feca2ed3
JW
6012inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6013
6014@smallexample
6015#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6016@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6017@end defmac
feca2ed3 6018
a2c4f8e0 6019@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
9e7adcb3
JH
6020A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6021comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6022@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6023machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6024instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6025freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6026like:
6027
6028@smallexample
6029#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
c771326b 6030 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
9e7adcb3
JH
6031 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6032@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6033@end defmac
9e7adcb3 6034
ab7e224a 6035@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
e129d93a
ILT
6036On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6037register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6038regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6039hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6040small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6041to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6042arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6043When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
ab7e224a 6044integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
e129d93a
ILT
6045@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6046
6047The default version of this hook returns false.
6048@end deftypefn
6049
ab7e224a 6050@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
e129d93a
ILT
6051On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6052@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6053validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6054target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6055both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6056return @code{VOIDmode}.
6057
6058The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6059same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6060returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6061@end deftypefn
6062
ac7eb5c6 6063@node Cond Exec Macros
f90b7a5a
PB
6064@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6065@findex conditional execution
6066@findex predication
6067
6068There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6069supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6070represent conditional branches.
6071
6072@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6073A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6074@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6075versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6076predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6077that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6078If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6079
6080@smallexample
6081#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6082 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6083@end smallexample
6084@end defmac
6085
feca2ed3
JW
6086@node Costs
6087@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6088@cindex costs of instructions
6089@cindex relative costs
6090@cindex speed of instructions
6091
6092These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6093on the target machine.
6094
a2c4f8e0 6095@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
e56b4594
AO
6096A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6097register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6098expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6099value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6100that.
feca2ed3
JW
6101
6102It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6103same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6104registers if they are not general registers.
6105
6106If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6107hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6108classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6109constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6110allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6111if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
de8f4b07
AS
6112
6113These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6114@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6115@end defmac
feca2ed3 6116
a87cf97e 6117@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
de8f4b07
AS
6118This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6119from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6120are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6121A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6122that.
6123
6124It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6125same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6126registers if they are not general registers.
6127
6128If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6129hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6130classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6131constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6132allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6133if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6134
6135The default version of this function returns 2.
6136@end deftypefn
6137
a2c4f8e0 6138@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
cbd5b9a2
KR
6139A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6140register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
df2a54e9 6141is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
473fe49b
KR
6142is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6143registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6144should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6145
a3a15b4d 6146If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
38e01259 6147the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
473fe49b
KR
6148needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6149between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6150more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6151reflect the actual cost of the move.
6152
a3a15b4d 6153GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
473fe49b
KR
6154secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6155a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6156secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61574 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6158value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6159are the same as to this macro.
f5c21ef3
AS
6160
6161These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6162@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6163@end defmac
cbd5b9a2 6164
a87cf97e 6165@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
f5c21ef3 6166This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6167between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
f5c21ef3 6168if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
de8f4b07
AS
6169This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6170If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6171registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
f5c21ef3
AS
6172
6173If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6174the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6175needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6176between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
f5c21ef3
AS
6177more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6178reflect the actual cost of the move.
6179
6180GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6181secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6182a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6183secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61844 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6185value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6186are the same as to this target hook.
6187@end deftypefn
6188
3a4fd356
JH
6189@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6190A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6191default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6192is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6193it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6194rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6195predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6196reduced then.
a2c4f8e0 6197@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
6198
6199Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
a3a15b4d 6200but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
feca2ed3
JW
6201ordinarily expect.
6202
a2c4f8e0 6203@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
feca2ed3 6204Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
e979f9e8 6205than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
feca2ed3
JW
6206faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6207require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6208between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6209
6210When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6211finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6212load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6213faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6214may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6215other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
a2c4f8e0 6216@end defmac
feca2ed3 6217
a2c4f8e0 6218@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5fad8ebf
DE
6219Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6220@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6221than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6222handler.
feca2ed3 6223
df2a54e9
JM
6224When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6225@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
feca2ed3 6226moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
df2a54e9 6227Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
feca2ed3
JW
6228cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6229
6be57663 6230If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
df2a54e9
JM
6231this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6232@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
a2c4f8e0 6233@end defmac
feca2ed3 6234
65a324b4 6235@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
9862dea9 6236The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
c5c76735 6237which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
feca2ed3
JW
6238string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6239make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6240
c5c76735
JL
6241Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6242@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6243the number of such sequences.
9862dea9 6244
65a324b4
NC
6245The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6246optimized for speed rather than size.
6247
feca2ed3 6248If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6249@end defmac
feca2ed3 6250
a2c4f8e0 6251@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
fbe1758d
AM
6252A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6253copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6e01bd94 6254will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
fbe1758d 6255than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6256@end defmac
fbe1758d 6257
a2c4f8e0 6258@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
fbe1758d 6259A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6e01bd94 6260a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
a2c4f8e0 6261@end defmac
fbe1758d 6262
65a324b4 6263@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
78762e3b
RS
6264The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6265of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6266or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6267eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6268
65a324b4
NC
6269The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6270optimized for speed rather than size.
6271
78762e3b 6272If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6273@end defmac
78762e3b 6274
a2c4f8e0 6275@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
78762e3b
RS
6276A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6277to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6278will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6279than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6280@end defmac
78762e3b 6281
65a324b4 6282@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
cfa31150
SL
6283The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6284of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6285a block set insn or a library call.
6286Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6287eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6288
65a324b4
NC
6289The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6290optimized for speed rather than size.
6291
cfa31150
SL
6292If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6293@end defmac
6294
6295@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6296A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6297used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6298other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6299storing values other than constant zero.
6300Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6301than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6302@end defmac
6303
a2c4f8e0 6304@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4977bab6 6305A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
65a324b4 6306used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
cfa31150
SL
6307other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6308called with a constant source string.
0bdcd332 6309Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
45d78e7f 6310than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6311@end defmac
4977bab6 6312
a2c4f8e0 6313@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6314A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6315thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6316@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6317@end defmac
6e01bd94 6318
a2c4f8e0 6319@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6320A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6321thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6322@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6323@end defmac
fbe1758d 6324
a2c4f8e0 6325@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6326A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6327thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6328@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6329@end defmac
6e01bd94 6330
a2c4f8e0 6331@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6332A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6333thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6334@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6335@end defmac
fbe1758d 6336
a2c4f8e0 6337@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6338A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6339thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6340@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6341@end defmac
6e01bd94 6342
a2c4f8e0 6343@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c771326b 6344A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6e01bd94
MH
6345thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6346@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6347@end defmac
fbe1758d 6348
a2c4f8e0 6349@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6350This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6351thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6352@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6353@end defmac
6e01bd94 6354
a2c4f8e0 6355@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6356This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6357thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6358@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6359@end defmac
fbe1758d 6360
a2c4f8e0 6361@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
feca2ed3
JW
6362Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6363function address than to call an address kept in a register.
a2c4f8e0 6364@end defmac
feca2ed3 6365
a2c4f8e0 6366@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
85e50b6b
DE
6367Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6368@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6369@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
a2c4f8e0 6370@end defmac
feca2ed3 6371
65a324b4 6372@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
3c50106f
RH
6373This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6374
6375The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6376available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6377in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6378expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6379@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6380
6381In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6382@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6383instructions.
6384
6385On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6386for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
31a52b86
RS
6387necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6388for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6389operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6390
65a324b4
NC
6391When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6392false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
31a52b86 6393size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
3c50106f
RH
6394
6395The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6396processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6397@end deftypefn
6398
65a324b4 6399@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, bool @var{speed})
10154ff8
RH
6400This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6401@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6402the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6403
6404For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6405true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6406instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6407all addresses will have equal costs.
6408
6409In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6410the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6411cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6412
6413For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6414and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6415is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6416references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6417the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6418that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6419instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6420specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6421
6422This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6423
6424On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6425cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6426@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6427be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6428@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6429should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6430should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6431registers on machines with lots of registers.
6432@end deftypefn
6433
c237e94a
ZW
6434@node Scheduling
6435@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6436
6437The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6438adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6439hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6440them: try the first ones in this list first.
6441
6442@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
fae15c93
VM
6443This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6444issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6445Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6446an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6447constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6448hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6449This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6450it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
c237e94a
ZW
6451@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6452@end deftypefn
6453
6454@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6455This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6456from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
3ee04299
DE
6457still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6458@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6459@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6460You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6461than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6462@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6463debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6464@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6465was scheduled.
c237e94a
ZW
6466@end deftypefn
6467
6468@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
fae15c93
VM
6469This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6470relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6471dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6472is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6473to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
c237e94a 6474that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
fae15c93
VM
6475data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6476description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6477output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6478times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6479acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
fa0aee89 6480@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
c237e94a
ZW
6481@end deftypefn
6482
6483@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6484This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
496d7bb0
MK
6485@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6486execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
c237e94a
ZW
6487later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6488scheduling priorities of insns.
6489@end deftypefn
6490
6491@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6492This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6493list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6494combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6495@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6496debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6497@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6498list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6499a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6500reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
65a324b4 6501@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
c237e94a
ZW
6502is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6503the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6504can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6505@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6506@end deftypefn
6507
914d25dc 6508@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6509Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6510function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6511is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6512@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6513return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6514this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6515scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6516cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6517@end deftypefn
6518
30028c85
VM
6519@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6520This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6521chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6522correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6523example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6524analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6525dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6526calculated.
6527@end deftypefn
6528
c237e94a
ZW
6529@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6530This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6531instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6532pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6533is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6534@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6535region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
431ae0bf 6536scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
c237e94a
ZW
6537@end deftypefn
6538
6539@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6540This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6541instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6542cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6543is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6544to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6545@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6546@end deftypefn
6547
58565a33
SKG
6548@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6549This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6550@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6551@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6552@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6553@end deftypefn
6554
6555@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
8a36672b 6556This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
58565a33
SKG
6557@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6558@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
914d25dc 6561@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6562The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6563pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6564when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6565simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6566processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6567based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6568when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6569@end deftypefn
6570
6571@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6572The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6573@end deftypefn
6574
914d25dc 6575@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6576The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6577to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6578simulated processor cycle finishes.
6579@end deftypefn
6580
6581@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6582The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6583used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6584@end deftypefn
6585
914d25dc 6586@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6587The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6588The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6589to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6590state on a single insn is not enough.
6591@end deftypefn
6592
914d25dc 6593@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6594The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6595The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6596to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6597state on a single insn is not enough.
6598@end deftypefn
6599
fae15c93
VM
6600@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6601This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6602for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6603chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6604value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6605@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6606subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6607maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6608@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6609packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6610rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6611
6612This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6613processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6614with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6615@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6616@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6617processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6618@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6619until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6620the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6621
6622Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6623pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6624schedules to choose the best one.
6625
6626The default is no multipass scheduling.
6627@end deftypefn
6628
914d25dc 6629@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
30028c85
VM
6630
6631This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6632considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
914d25dc 6633zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
30028c85
VM
6634be issued.
6635
62b9c42c 6636The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
30028c85
VM
6637@end deftypefn
6638
894fd6f2
MK
6639@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6640This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6641scheduling.
6642@end deftypefn
6643
6644@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6645This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6646@end deftypefn
6647
6648@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6649This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6650an instruction.
6651@end deftypefn
6652
6653@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6654This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6655round of multipass scheduling.
6656@end deftypefn
6657
6658@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6659This hook initilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6660@end deftypefn
6661
6662@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6663This hook finilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6664@end deftypefn
6665
a934eb2d 6666@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
a934eb2d
JR
6667This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6668on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6669@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6670the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6671is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6672start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6673verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6674@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6675processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6676and the current processor cycle.
30028c85
VM
6677@end deftypefn
6678
72392b81 6679@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
569fa502 6680This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
daf2f129 6681the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
569fa502 6682are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
b198261f
MK
6683to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6684being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
72392b81 6685dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
daf2f129 6686parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
569fa502
DN
6687The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6688insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6689and @code{false} otherwise.
6690
6691Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
daf2f129 6692where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
569fa502 6693delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
daf2f129 6694that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
569fa502 6695important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
78466c0e 6696closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
72392b81 6697not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
569fa502
DN
6698@end deftypefn
6699
496d7bb0
MK
6700@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6701This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6702the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6703per instruction data structures.
6704@end deftypefn
6705
b6fd8800 6706@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e855c69d
AB
6707Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6708@end deftypefn
6709
6710@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6711Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6712It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
ab7e224a 6713beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e855c69d
AB
6714@end deftypefn
6715
6716@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
914d25dc 6717Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e855c69d
AB
6718@end deftypefn
6719
6720@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6721Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6722@end deftypefn
6723
6724@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6725Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6726@end deftypefn
6727
496d7bb0 6728@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
64ee9490
EC
6729This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6730speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6731The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6732version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6733pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
8ad1dde7 6734or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
496d7bb0
MK
6735speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6736the generated speculative pattern.
6737@end deftypefn
6738
72392b81 6739@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
496d7bb0 6740This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
72392b81
JR
6741for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6742instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
496d7bb0
MK
6743@end deftypefn
6744
914d25dc 6745@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
496d7bb0 6746This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
64ee9490
EC
6747check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6748speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6749@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6750be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6751recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6752a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
496d7bb0
MK
6753@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6754@end deftypefn
6755
5498b6d2 6756@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
496d7bb0
MK
6757This hook is used as a workaround for
6758@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6759called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
5498b6d2
JR
6760discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6761being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6762@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6763For non-speculative instructions,
6764the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
496d7bb0
MK
6765the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6766is nearly full.
6767@end deftypefn
6768
50e87e30 6769@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
64ee9490 6770This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
50e87e30
JR
6771enabled/used.
6772The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
496d7bb0
MK
6773The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6774@end deftypefn
6775
67186a97
TS
6776@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6777This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6778resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6779the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6780backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6781bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6782of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6783@end deftypefn
6784
7942e47e
RY
6785@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6786This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6787is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6788@end deftypefn
6789
6790@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6791This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6792in its second parameter.
6793@end deftypefn
6794
feca2ed3
JW
6795@node Sections
6796@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6797@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6798@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6799
6800An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6801data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6802section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6803section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6804section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6805of sections.
6806
d6b5193b
RS
6807@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6808@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6809The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6810is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6811as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6812initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6813They may however depend on command-line flags.
6814
6815@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6816use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6817to be string literals.
6818
6819Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6820section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6821should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6822@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6823
6824You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6825@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6826in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6827@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6828create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6829reuse @code{text_section}.
6830
6831All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6832if the target does not provide them.
feca2ed3 6833
a2c4f8e0 6834@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6835A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6836assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6837Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6838@end defmac
33c09f2f 6839
a2c4f8e0 6840@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6841If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6842frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6843a default definition if the target supports named sections.
a2c4f8e0 6844@end defmac
194734e9 6845
a2c4f8e0 6846@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6847If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6848executed functions in the program.
a2c4f8e0 6849@end defmac
194734e9 6850
a2c4f8e0 6851@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6852A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6853assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6854data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6855@end defmac
feca2ed3 6856
d6b5193b
RS
6857@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6858If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6859containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6860initialized, writable small data.
6861@end defmac
6862
a2c4f8e0 6863@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
d48bc59a
RH
6864A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6865assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6866data.
a2c4f8e0 6867@end defmac
d48bc59a 6868
a2c4f8e0 6869@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6870If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6871containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6872uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6873@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6874uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
630d3d5a 6875@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
047c1c92 6876used.
a2c4f8e0 6877@end defmac
feca2ed3 6878
d6b5193b
RS
6879@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6880If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6881containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6882uninitialized, writable small data.
6883@end defmac
6884
9b7e6950
RO
6885@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6886If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6887assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6888common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6889@end defmac
6890
6891@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6892If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6893containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6894default is @code{'T'}.
6895@end defmac
6896
a2c4f8e0 6897@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6898If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6899containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6900initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6901not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6902variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6903@end defmac
feca2ed3 6904
a2c4f8e0 6905@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6906If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6909not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6910variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6911@end defmac
750054a2 6912
7abc66b1
JB
6913@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6914If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6915containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6916part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6917defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6918both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6919@end defmac
083cad55 6920
7abc66b1
JB
6921@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6922If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6923containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6924part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6925defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6926both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6927@end defmac
6928
a2c4f8e0 6929@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
cea3bd3e
RH
6930If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6931via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6932the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6933@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6934to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6935sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
1b2dd04a
AO
6936ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6937registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6938constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 6939@end defmac
1b2dd04a 6940
a0cfeb0f
DD
6941@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6942If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6943variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6944when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6945you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6946they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6947expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6948MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6949require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6950to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6951access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
726e9992 6952@end defmac
a0cfeb0f 6953
a2c4f8e0 6954@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
cea3bd3e
RH
6955If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6956arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6957@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6958and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
a2c4f8e0 6959@end defmac
cea3bd3e 6960
a2c4f8e0 6961@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
df2a54e9 6962Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
75197b37
BS
6963tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6964section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6965readonly data section is used.
feca2ed3
JW
6966
6967This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
a2c4f8e0 6968@end defmac
feca2ed3 6969
d6b5193b
RS
6970@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
6971Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6972@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6973of its own that you need to create.
6974
6975GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6976any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6977described below.
6978@end deftypefn
6979
914d25dc 6980@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
9b580a0b
RH
6981Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6982selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6983should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6984local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6985
6986The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6987is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6988when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6989in read-only sections even in executables.
6990@end deftypefn
6991
d6b5193b
RS
6992@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6993Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
ae46c4e0
RH
6994assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6995some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6996requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6997local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
d6b5193b 6998@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
ae46c4e0
RH
6999
7000The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7001variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
09afda70
GK
7002
7003See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
ae46c4e0
RH
7004@end deftypefn
7005
09afda70
GK
7006@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7007Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7008for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7009
7010In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7011function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7012it is unlikely to be called.
7013@end defmac
7014
ae46c4e0
RH
7015@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7016Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7017and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7018As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7019the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7020
7021The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7022ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7023example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7024Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7025@end deftypefn
7026
d6b5193b
RS
7027@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7028Return the readonly data section associated with
ab5c8549 7029@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
d6b5193b
RS
7030The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7031the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7032if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7033otherwise.
ab5c8549
JJ
7034@end deftypefn
7035
d6b5193b
RS
7036@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7037Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7038should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
b64a1b53 7039constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
d6b5193b
RS
7040case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7041in bits.
b64a1b53
RH
7042
7043The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7044constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7045else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7046@end deftypefn
7047
914d25dc 7048@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
5234b8f5
DS
7049Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7050by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7051the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7052or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7053hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7054your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7055returns the @var{id} provided.
7056@end deftypefn
7057
c6a2438a 7058@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
fb49053f
RH
7059Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7060treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7061function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7062
c6a2438a
ZW
7063The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7064@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7065an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7066rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
0864034e 7067in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
c6a2438a
ZW
7068
7069In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7070a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7071will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7072register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7073rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7074leave it alone.)
fb49053f
RH
7075
7076The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
c6a2438a 7077that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
fb49053f
RH
7078be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7079declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7080declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
c6a2438a 7081@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
fb49053f
RH
7082
7083@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
c6a2438a
ZW
7084The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7085@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7086Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7087encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7088discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7089
7090The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7091in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7092@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7093before overriding it.
fb49053f
RH
7094@end deftypefn
7095
914d25dc 7096@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
772c5265
RH
7097Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7098the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7099may have added.
7100@end deftypefn
7101
b6fd8800 7102@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7103Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7104The default version of this hook always returns false.
7105@end deftypefn
7106
9e3be889 7107@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
e2a6476e
DE
7108Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7109``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
9e3be889 7110@end deftypevr
e2a6476e 7111
3c5273a9
KT
7112@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7113It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7114
7115The default version of this hook use the target macro
7116@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7117@end deftypefn
7118
b6fd8800 7119@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7120Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7121rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7122or executable image).
7123
7124The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7125for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7126currently supported object file formats.
7127@end deftypefn
7128
9e3be889 7129@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
e2a6476e
DE
7130Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7131The default value is false.
9e3be889 7132@end deftypevr
e2a6476e
DE
7133
7134
feca2ed3
JW
7135@node PIC
7136@section Position Independent Code
7137@cindex position independent code
7138@cindex PIC
7139
7140This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7141independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
c6c3dba9
PB
7142generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7143@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7144@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7145must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7146when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7147need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7148relative addresses.
7149@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
feca2ed3
JW
7150@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7151
a2c4f8e0 7152@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
7153The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7154data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
161d7b59 7155processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
feca2ed3
JW
7156is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7157pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7158is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
003b9f78 7159necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
12beba6f 7160when @code{flag_pic} is true).
a2c4f8e0 7161@end defmac
feca2ed3 7162
a2c4f8e0 7163@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7164A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7165@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7166the default is zero. Do not define
ed4db1ee 7167this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
a2c4f8e0 7168@end defmac
feca2ed3 7169
a2c4f8e0 7170@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
7171A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7172operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7173You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7174check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7175check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7176(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7177position independent code.
a2c4f8e0 7178@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7179
7180@node Assembler Format
7181@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7182
7183This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
648c546a 7184to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
feca2ed3
JW
7185instructions do.
7186
7187@menu
7188* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7189* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7190* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7191* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7192* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6ccde948 7193 and termination routines.
feca2ed3 7194* Macros for Initialization::
6ccde948
RW
7195 Specific macros that control the handling of
7196 initialization and termination routines.
feca2ed3
JW
7197* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7198* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7199* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7200* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7201@end menu
7202
7203@node File Framework
7204@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7205@cindex assembler format
7206@cindex output of assembler code
7207
7208@c prevent bad page break with this line
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7209This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7210
1bc7c5b6 7211@findex default_file_start
914d25dc 7212@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7213Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7214find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7215by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7216quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7217@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7218lets other target files rely on these variables.
7219@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7220
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7221@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7222If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7223printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7224@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7225to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7226definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7227assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7228whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7229
7230The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7231verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7232comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7233@end deftypevr
7234
7235@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7236If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7237for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7238@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7239this to be done. The default is false.
7240@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 7241
b6fd8800 7242@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
a5fe455b
ZW
7243Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7244to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7245@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7246
a5fe455b
ZW
7247@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7248Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7249special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7250the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7251should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7252need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7253this function.
7254@end deftypefun
feca2ed3 7255
c082f9f3
SB
7256@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7257Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7258to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7259nothing.
7260@end deftypefn
7261
7262@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7263Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7264to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7265nothing.
7266@end deftypefn
7267
6d217c32
JJ
7268@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7269Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7270unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7271here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7272because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7273nothing.
7274@end deftypefn
7275
a2c4f8e0 7276@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
feca2ed3
JW
7277A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7278assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7279the end of the line.
a2c4f8e0 7280@end defmac
feca2ed3 7281
a2c4f8e0 7282@defmac ASM_APP_ON
feca2ed3
JW
7283A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7284statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7285@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7286assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7287that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
a2c4f8e0 7288@end defmac
feca2ed3 7289
a2c4f8e0 7290@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
feca2ed3
JW
7291A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7292statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7293@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7294time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
a2c4f8e0 7295@end defmac
feca2ed3 7296
a2c4f8e0 7297@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7298A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7299which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7300the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7301
7302This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7303for the file format in use is appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 7304@end defmac
feca2ed3 7305
b5f5d41d
AS
7306@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7307Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7308
7309 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7310@end deftypefn
7311
a2c4f8e0 7312@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
e9a25f70
JL
7313A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7314@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
a3a15b4d 7315in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
e9a25f70
JL
7316the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7317of the filename using this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7318@end defmac
e9a25f70 7319
a2c4f8e0 7320@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
feca2ed3
JW
7321A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7322@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7323macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
a2c4f8e0 7324@end defmac
feca2ed3 7325
914d25dc 7326@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7c262518
RH
7327Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7328should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
914d25dc
JR
7329of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7330is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7331this section is associated.
7c262518
RH
7332@end deftypefn
7333
f16d3f39
JH
7334@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7335Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7336Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7337functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7338at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7339@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7340(from static destructors).
7341Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7342@end deftypefn
7343
914d25dc 7344@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7c262518 7345This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7346It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
914d25dc 7347@end deftypevr
7c262518 7348
434aeebb 7349@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
914d25dc 7350@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
434aeebb
RS
7351This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7352section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7353This is true on most ELF targets.
914d25dc 7354@end deftypevr
434aeebb 7355
7c262518
RH
7356@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7357Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7358based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7359declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6ccde948 7360null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7c262518 7361
224504d2 7362The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7c262518
RH
7363read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7364need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7365set via @code{__attribute__}.
7366@end deftypefn
7367
b6fd8800 7368@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
e0d9d0dd
NC
7369Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7370switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7371enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7372It can take the following values:
7373
7374@table @gcctabopt
7375@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7376@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7377
7378@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7379@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7380direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7381default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7382command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7383various different individual optimization passes.
7384
7385@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7386@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7387ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7388target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7389time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7390warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7391wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7392necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7393perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7394switches.
7395
7396@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7397This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7398
7399@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7400This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7401@end table
7402
7403The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7404supported in the future.
7405
7406By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7407provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7408it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7409section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7410provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7411hook.
7412@end deftypefn
7413
914d25dc 7414@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
e0d9d0dd
NC
7415This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7416ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7417hook.
914d25dc 7418@end deftypevr
e0d9d0dd 7419
feca2ed3
JW
7420@need 2000
7421@node Data Output
7422@subsection Output of Data
7423
301d03af
RS
7424
7425@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7426@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7427@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7428@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7429@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7430@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7431@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7432@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7433@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7434These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7435of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7436byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7437aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7438@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7439
7440The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7441followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7442the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7443@end deftypevr
7444
7445@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7446The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7447integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7448in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7449function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7450object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7451split the object into smaller parts.
7452
7453The default implementation of this hook will use the
7454@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7455when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7456@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7457
6cbd8875
AS
7458@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7459A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7460can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7461the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7462@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7463
7464If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7465so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7466itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7467return @code{true}.
7468@end deftypefn
7469
a2c4f8e0 7470@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
422be3c3
AO
7471A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7472@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7473@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7474allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7475
7476If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7477@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7478prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7479@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
a2c4f8e0 7480@end defmac
422be3c3 7481
a2c4f8e0 7482@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
feca2ed3
JW
7483A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7484instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7485bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7486@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7487
7488If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7489Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7490@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
a2c4f8e0 7491@end defmac
feca2ed3 7492
a2c4f8e0 7493@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
67231816
RH
7494A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7495@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7496is defined, and is otherwise unused.
a2c4f8e0 7497@end defmac
67231816 7498
a2c4f8e0 7499@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
861bb6c1 7500You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
df2a54e9 7501expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
861bb6c1 7502pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
a3a15b4d
JL
7503GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7504not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
861bb6c1 7505pool before the function.
a2c4f8e0 7506@end defmac
861bb6c1 7507
a2c4f8e0 7508@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
feca2ed3
JW
7509A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7510constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7511the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7512be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7513is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7514immediately after this call.
7515
7516If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7517not be defined.
a2c4f8e0 7518@end defmac
feca2ed3 7519
a2c4f8e0 7520@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
feca2ed3
JW
7521A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7522constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7523anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7524
7525The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7526assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7527output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7528@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7529@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7530alignment.
7531
7532The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7533the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7534responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7535Here is how to do this:
7536
3ab51846 7537@smallexample
4977bab6 7538@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
3ab51846 7539@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
7540
7541When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7542@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7543entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7544
7545You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7546@end defmac
feca2ed3 7547
a2c4f8e0 7548@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
861bb6c1
JL
7549A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7550pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7551function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7552obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
a3a15b4d 7553constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
861bb6c1
JL
7554
7555If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7556define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7557@end defmac
861bb6c1 7558
980d8882 7559@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
feca2ed3 7560Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
980d8882
BS
7561used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7562to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7563a line separator uses multiple characters.
feca2ed3
JW
7564
7565If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7566the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
a2c4f8e0 7567@end defmac
feca2ed3 7568
8ca83838 7569@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
baed53ac 7570@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
17b53c33
NB
7571These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7572assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7573default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8ca83838 7574@end deftypevr
17b53c33 7575
6ccde948 7576These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
feca2ed3
JW
7577of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7578
a2c4f8e0
ZW
7579@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7580@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7581@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
dadb213f
BE
7582@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7583@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7584@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7585These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7586target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7587the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7588@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7589simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7590@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7591by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7592it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
759332 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7594on the host machine.
feca2ed3
JW
7595
7596The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7597using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7598machine's memory.
a2c4f8e0 7599@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7600
7601@node Uninitialized Data
7602@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7603
7604Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7605outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7606
a2c4f8e0 7607@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7608A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7609@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7610@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
233215fe
DK
7611is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7612possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7613other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7614backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7615byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7616equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7617the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7618an ordinary undefined external.
feca2ed3
JW
7619
7620Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7621output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7622assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7623
7624This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7625common global variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7626@end defmac
feca2ed3 7627
a2c4f8e0 7628@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7629Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7630separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7631place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7632handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7633as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7634@end defmac
feca2ed3 7635
a2c4f8e0 7636@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7637Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7638variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7639is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7640in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7641@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7642the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7643@end defmac
e9a25f70 7644
a2c4f8e0 7645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7646A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7647@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7648@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7649is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7650
7651Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7652defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7653@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7654before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7655the name, and a newline.
7656
0ee2ea09 7657There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
434aeebb
RS
7658this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7659The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7660switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7661You do not need to do both.
7662
7663Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7664non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7665efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7666not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7667common in order to save space in the object file.
a2c4f8e0 7668@end defmac
feca2ed3 7669
a2c4f8e0 7670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7671Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7672separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7673place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7674handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7675as the number of bits.
7676
7677Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7678@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7679@end defmac
feca2ed3 7680
a2c4f8e0 7681@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7682A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7683@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7684@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7685is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7686
7687Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7688output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7689assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7690
7691This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7692static variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7693@end defmac
feca2ed3 7694
a2c4f8e0 7695@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7696Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7697separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7698place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7699handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7700as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7701@end defmac
feca2ed3 7702
a2c4f8e0 7703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7704Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7705variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7706is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7707in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7708@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7709the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7710@end defmac
e9a25f70 7711
feca2ed3
JW
7712@node Label Output
7713@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7714
7715@c prevent bad page break with this line
7716This is about outputting labels.
7717
feca2ed3 7718@findex assemble_name
a2c4f8e0 7719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7720A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7721@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7722Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7723output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
4ad5e05d
KG
7724assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7725definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 7726@end defmac
feca2ed3 7727
135a687e
KT
7728@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7729A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7730@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7731a function.
7732Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7733output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7734assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7735definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7736
7737If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7738usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7739@end defmac
7740
57829bc4
MM
7741@findex assemble_name_raw
7742@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
e374d5c9 7743Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
57829bc4
MM
7744to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7745@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7746that it is more efficient.
7747@end defmac
7748
a2c4f8e0 7749@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7750A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7751size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7752default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7753systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7754
7755Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7756of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7757for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7758macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7759define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7760@end defmac
2be2ac70 7761
a2c4f8e0 7762@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
2be2ac70
ZW
7763A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7765symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7766If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7767provided.
a2c4f8e0 7768@end defmac
2be2ac70 7769
a2c4f8e0 7770@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
2be2ac70
ZW
7771A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7772@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
99086d59 7773the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
73774972 7774address.
99086d59
ZW
7775
7776If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7777provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7778@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7779the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7780not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7781to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
a2c4f8e0 7782@end defmac
2be2ac70 7783
a2c4f8e0 7784@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7785A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7786type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7787default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7788systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7789
7790Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7791@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7792custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7793types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7794@end defmac
2be2ac70 7795
a2c4f8e0 7796@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
2be2ac70
ZW
7797A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7798the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7799default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7800the default is not to define this macro.
7801
7802Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7803@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7804custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7805types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7806@end defmac
2be2ac70 7807
a2c4f8e0 7808@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
2be2ac70
ZW
7809A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7810@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7811symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7812that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7813you should not count on this.
7814
7815If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7816definition of this macro is provided.
a2c4f8e0 7817@end defmac
2be2ac70 7818
a2c4f8e0 7819@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7820A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7821@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7822function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7823outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7824@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
feca2ed3
JW
7825@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7826
7827If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7828usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
feca2ed3 7829
2be2ac70
ZW
7830You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7831of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7832@end defmac
2be2ac70 7833
a2c4f8e0 7834@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7835A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7837which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7838function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7839representing the function.
7840
7841If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7842
2be2ac70
ZW
7843You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7844of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7845@end defmac
2be2ac70 7846
a2c4f8e0 7847@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7848A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7849@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7850initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7851label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7852@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7853
7854If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7855usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7856
2be2ac70
ZW
7857You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7858@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7859@end defmac
2be2ac70 7860
ad78130c 7861@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
e4f7c483
AS
7862A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7863for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7864target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7865@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7866and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7867will be an internal label.
18f3e349 7868
e4f7c483
AS
7869The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7870usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
18f3e349 7871
e4f7c483
AS
7872You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7873@end deftypefn
18f3e349 7874
a2c4f8e0 7875@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
1cb36a98
RH
7876A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7877@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7878for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7879
7880If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7881nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7882@end defmac
1cb36a98 7883
a2c4f8e0 7884@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
feca2ed3
JW
7885A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7886once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7887chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7888initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7889something about the size of the object.
7890
7891If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7892nothing.
7893
2be2ac70
ZW
7894You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7895@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7896@end defmac
2be2ac70 7897
5eb99654
KG
7898@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7899This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
feca2ed3 7900@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
5eb99654 7901that is, available for reference from other files.
feca2ed3 7902
5eb99654
KG
7903The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7904@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
b65d23aa 7905@end deftypefn
072cdaed 7906
812b587e
SE
7907@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7908This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7909@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7910global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7911
7912The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7913@end deftypefn
7914
a2c4f8e0 7915@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7916A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7917@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7918that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7919no other definition is available. Use the expression
7920@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7921itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7922for making that name weak, and a newline.
7923
79c4e63f
AM
7924If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7925support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7926macro.
a2c4f8e0 7927@end defmac
79c4e63f 7928
a2c4f8e0 7929@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
79c4e63f
AM
7930Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7931@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7932or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7933should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7934defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7935@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7936to make @var{name} weak.
a2c4f8e0 7937@end defmac
feca2ed3 7938
ff2d10c1
AO
7939@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7940Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7941symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7942declaration of @code{name}.
7943@end defmac
7944
a2c4f8e0 7945@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7946A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7947supports weak symbols.
feca2ed3
JW
7948
7949If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
79c4e63f 7950definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7951is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7952@end defmac
7953
7954@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7955A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7956
7957If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7958definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7959this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7960flag such as @option{-melf}.
a2c4f8e0 7961@end defmac
feca2ed3 7962
a2c4f8e0 7963@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7964A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7965public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7966be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7967format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7968section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7969requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
a2c4f8e0 7970@end defmac
feca2ed3 7971
a2c4f8e0 7972@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
feca2ed3
JW
7973A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7974semantics.
7975
7976If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7977definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7978definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
e9a25f70 7979you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
feca2ed3
JW
7980setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7981be emitted as one-only.
a2c4f8e0 7982@end defmac
feca2ed3 7983
914d25dc 7984@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
93638d7a
AM
7985This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7986commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7987hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7988@end deftypefn
7989
0524c91d 7990@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
4746cf84 7991A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
0524c91d 7992that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
f676971a 7993The default is @code{0}.
0524c91d
MA
7994
7995Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7996if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7997will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7998symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7999thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8000(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8001with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8002
8003The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8004targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8005restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8006table of contents.
4746cf84
MA
8007@end defmac
8008
a2c4f8e0 8009@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8010A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8011@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8012symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8013not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8014declaration.
8015
8016This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8017The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
a2c4f8e0 8018@end defmac
feca2ed3 8019
6773a41c
RO
8020@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8021This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
feca2ed3 8022pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6773a41c
RO
8023library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8024@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8025
914d25dc 8026@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8e3e233b 8027This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
914d25dc
JR
8028directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8029.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8e3e233b
DP
8030@end deftypefn
8031
a2c4f8e0 8032@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8033A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8034@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8035@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8036is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8037systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
a2c4f8e0 8038@end defmac
feca2ed3 8039
a2c4f8e0 8040@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
99c8c61c 8041A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
2f0b7af6 8042@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
99c8c61c
AO
8043will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8044to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
fb49053f 8045encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 8046@end defmac
99c8c61c 8047
a2c4f8e0 8048@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
2f0b7af6 8049A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
4226378a 8050result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
2f0b7af6
GK
8051@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8052This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8053specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
4226378a
PK
8054when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8055being taken.
a2c4f8e0 8056@end defmac
2f0b7af6 8057
4977bab6
ZW
8058@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8059A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8060name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
feca2ed3
JW
8061
8062It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8063used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8064will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8065
8066It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8067object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8068should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8069beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8070convention your system uses, and follow it.
8071
8a36672b 8072The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
4977bab6 8073@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8074
a2c4f8e0 8075@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8215347e
JW
8076A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8077label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8078@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8079may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8080systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8081bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8082bundles.
8083
4977bab6 8084If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8215347e 8085used.
a2c4f8e0 8086@end defmac
8215347e 8087
a2c4f8e0 8088@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
8089A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8090is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8091
8092This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
4977bab6 8093produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
feca2ed3
JW
8094with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8095
8096If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8097output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8098@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8099string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8100to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8101@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8102you should know what it does on your machine.)
a2c4f8e0 8103@end defmac
feca2ed3 8104
a2c4f8e0 8105@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
feca2ed3
JW
8106A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8107@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8108@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8109added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8110
8111The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8112produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8113@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8114assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8115macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8116internal static variables in different scopes.
8117
8118Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8119conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8120or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8121between the name and the number will suffice.
8122
4977bab6
ZW
8123If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8124which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8125@end defmac
4977bab6 8126
a2c4f8e0 8127@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8128A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8129which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8130
203cb4ef 8131@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8132If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
feca2ed3 8133correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8134@end defmac
810e3c45 8135
a2c4f8e0 8136@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
e4faf1eb 8137A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
3b7a2e58 8138which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
e4faf1eb
NC
8139to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8140be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8141the tree nodes are available.
8142
203cb4ef 8143@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8144If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
956d6950 8145correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8146@end defmac
956d6950 8147
083b6717
JDA
8148@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8149A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8150(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8151of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8152current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8153This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8154@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8155@end defmac
8156
a2c4f8e0 8157@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
810e3c45
JM
8158A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8159which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3aa8ab7b
L
8160@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8161an undefined weak symbol.
810e3c45
JM
8162
8163Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
aee96fe9 8164@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
a2c4f8e0 8165@end defmac
810e3c45 8166
a2c4f8e0 8167@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
feca2ed3 8168Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
2147b154 8169Objective-C methods.
feca2ed3
JW
8170
8171The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8172class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8173the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8174@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8175
8176These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8177the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8178systems define other ways of computing names.
8179
8180@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8181buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8182@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
818350 characters extra.
8184
8185The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8186method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
59d42021 8187@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
feca2ed3
JW
8188in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8189
8190On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8191macro to provide more human-readable names.
a2c4f8e0 8192@end defmac
28df0b5a 8193
a2c4f8e0 8194@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
f60b945b
SS
8195A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8196@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8197Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8198linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
a2c4f8e0 8199@end defmac
f60b945b 8200
a2c4f8e0 8201@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
28df0b5a
SS
8202A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8203@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8204unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8205whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
a2c4f8e0 8206@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8207
8208@node Initialization
8209@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8210@cindex initialization routines
8211@cindex termination routines
8212@cindex constructors, output of
8213@cindex destructors, output of
8214
8215The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8216(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8217data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8218to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8219@code{main} is called.
8220
8221Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8222@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8223terminates.
8224
8225To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8226must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8227be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8228system, you need to specify how to do this.
8229
8230There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8231initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8232Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8233
8234@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8235@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8236The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8237initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8238termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8239
8240Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82410, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8242the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8243pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8244pointer containing zero.
8245
8246Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8247@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8248time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8249list; destructors in forward order.
8250
8251The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8252formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8253aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8254Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8255object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8256the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8257accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8258Termination functions are handled similarly.
8259
2cc07db4
RH
8260This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8261@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
f282ffb3 8262support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
2cc07db4
RH
8263constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8264and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
feca2ed3
JW
8265
8266When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8267upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
2cc07db4 8268support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
feca2ed3 8269parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
05739753 8270program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
feca2ed3 8271
3ab51846 8272@smallexample
2cc07db4 8273ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
3ab51846 8274@end smallexample
feca2ed3 8275
2cc07db4
RH
8276The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8277section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8278for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8279files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8280are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8281
8282The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8283compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8284fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8285to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8286of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8287that invokes the routines we need at startup.
feca2ed3
JW
8288
8289To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8290macro properly.
8291
2cc07db4
RH
8292If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8293@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8294entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8295it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8296after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8297in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
feca2ed3
JW
8298
8299In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8300two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8301and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
2cc07db4 8302@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
feca2ed3
JW
8303entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8304and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8305code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
2cc07db4 8306the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
feca2ed3
JW
8307placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8308a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
2cc07db4 8309@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
feca2ed3
JW
8310section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8311the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8312the initialization process.
8313
8314The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8315This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
161d7b59 8316file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
2cc07db4
RH
8317this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8318termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8319an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8320pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8321the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8322initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8323via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8324@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
feca2ed3
JW
8325
8326@ifinfo
8327The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8328customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8329@end ifinfo
8330
8331@node Macros for Initialization
8332@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8333
8334Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8335and termination functions:
8336
a2c4f8e0 8337@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
8338If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8339operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8340defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8341using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8342macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8343run the initialization functions.
a2c4f8e0 8344@end defmac
feca2ed3 8345
a2c4f8e0 8346@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
feca2ed3 8347If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
2cc07db4
RH
8348This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8349on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8350be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
a2c4f8e0 8351@end defmac
feca2ed3 8352
a2c4f8e0 8353@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8354If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8355the following symbol is an initialization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8356@end defmac
feca2ed3 8357
a2c4f8e0 8358@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8359If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8360the following symbol is a finalization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8361@end defmac
feca2ed3 8362
a2c4f8e0 8363@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8364If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8365automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8366should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8367the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
172270b3 8368function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
414e05cf
RE
8369
8370This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
f282ffb3 8371shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
414e05cf 8372exception tables embedded in the code.
a2c4f8e0 8373@end defmac
414e05cf 8374
a2c4f8e0 8375@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8376If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8377automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8378should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8379the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
172270b3 8380function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
a2c4f8e0 8381@end defmac
414e05cf 8382
a2c4f8e0 8383@defmac INVOKE__main
feca2ed3
JW
8384If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8385@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8386where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8387useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
a2c4f8e0 8388@end defmac
feca2ed3 8389
a2c4f8e0 8390@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
ea4f1fce
JO
8391If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8392compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8393of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8394encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
a2c4f8e0 8395@end defmac
2cc07db4 8396
914d25dc 8397@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
2cc07db4
RH
8398This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8399collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8400It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
914d25dc 8401@end deftypevr
2cc07db4
RH
8402
8403@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8404If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8405the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
ea4f1fce 8406
2cc07db4
RH
8407Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8408no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8409priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8410otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8411
14976c58 8412If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
2cc07db4
RH
8413be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8414target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8415is not defined.
8416@end deftypefn
8417
8418@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8419This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
feca2ed3 8420functions rather than initialization functions.
2cc07db4 8421@end deftypefn
14686fcd 8422
2cc07db4
RH
8423If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8424generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
feca2ed3 8425
2cc07db4
RH
8426If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8427constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8428an object file for constructor functions to be called.
14686fcd 8429
4a023207 8430On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
2cc07db4 8431@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
feca2ed3 8432
a2c4f8e0 8433@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
feca2ed3 8434Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
2cc07db4 8435object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
feca2ed3 8436object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
feca2ed3 8437
4a023207 8438This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
2cc07db4 8439part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
a2c4f8e0 8440@end defmac
feca2ed3 8441
a2c4f8e0 8442@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
feca2ed3 8443Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
2cc07db4
RH
8444to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8445@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8446@end defmac
8447
8448@defmac NM_FLAGS
8449@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8450constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8451passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8452are needed to get the same output formut as GNU @command{nm -n}
8453produces.
8454@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8455
8456If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8457dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8458these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8459termination functions in shared libraries:
8460
a2c4f8e0 8461@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
2cc07db4 8462Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8463which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
a2c4f8e0 8464@end defmac
feca2ed3 8465
a2c4f8e0 8466@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
feca2ed3 8467Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
aee96fe9 8468of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
feca2ed3
JW
8469of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8470from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
aee96fe9
JM
8471code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8472line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
a2c4f8e0 8473@end defmac
feca2ed3 8474
881466d8
JDA
8475@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8476Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8477library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8478strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8479constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8480that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8481@end defmac
8482
feca2ed3
JW
8483@node Instruction Output
8484@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8485
8486@c prevent bad page break with this line
8487This describes assembler instruction output.
8488
a2c4f8e0 8489@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8490A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8491registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8492register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
a2c4f8e0 8493@end defmac
feca2ed3 8494
a2c4f8e0 8495@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8496If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8497and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8498registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8499to registers using alternate names.
a2c4f8e0 8500@end defmac
feca2ed3 8501
0c6d290e
RE
8502@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8503If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8504name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8505machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8506names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8507declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8508@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8509register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8510
8511This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8512@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8513register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8514VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8515``s0'' and ``s1''.
8516@end defmac
8517
a2c4f8e0 8518@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
feca2ed3
JW
8519Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8520requires different names for the machine instructions.
8521
8522The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8523assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8524macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8525points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8526written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8527opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8528increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8529so that it will not be output twice.
8530
8531In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8532name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8533that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8534care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8535@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8536
37bef197 8537@findex recog_data.operand
feca2ed3 8538If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
37bef197 8539elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
feca2ed3
JW
8540
8541If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8542in the usual way.
a2c4f8e0 8543@end defmac
feca2ed3 8544
a2c4f8e0 8545@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
feca2ed3
JW
8546If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8547assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8548they will be output differently.
8549
8550Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8551extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8552elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8553The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8554template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8555by changing the contents of the vector.
8556
8557This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8558file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8559can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8560as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8561syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8562writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8563
8564If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
a2c4f8e0 8565@end defmac
feca2ed3 8566
914d25dc 8567@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
1afc5373
CF
8568If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8569output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8570if necessary.
8571
8572Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8573extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8574elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8575The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8576template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8577by checking the contents of the vector.
8578@end deftypefn
8579
a2c4f8e0 8580@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8581A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8582assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8583RTL expression.
8584
8585@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8586of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8587printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8588the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8589operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8590@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8591@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8592
8593@findex reg_names
8594If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8595The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8596@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8597@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8598
8599When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8600(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8601with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8602@var{code}.
a2c4f8e0 8603@end defmac
feca2ed3 8604
a2c4f8e0 8605@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8606A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8607punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8608@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8609punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8610in this way.
a2c4f8e0 8611@end defmac
feca2ed3 8612
a2c4f8e0 8613@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
8614A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8615assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8616whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8617
fb49053f 8618@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
feca2ed3 8619On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
fb49053f
RH
8620section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8621@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8622@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8623Format}.
8624@end defmac
feca2ed3 8625
feca2ed3 8626@findex dbr_sequence_length
a2c4f8e0 8627@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
feca2ed3
JW
8628A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8629been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8630determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8631currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8632or whatever.
8633
8634Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8635reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
e979f9e8 8636explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
a2c4f8e0 8637@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8638
8639@findex final_sequence
8640Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
e979f9e8
JM
8641prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8642(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
feca2ed3
JW
8643found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8644processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8645being output.
8646
feca2ed3 8647@findex asm_fprintf
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8648@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8649@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8650@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8651@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
8652If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8653@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8654@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8655support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8656files can define these macros differently.
a2c4f8e0 8657@end defmac
feca2ed3 8658
a2c4f8e0 8659@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
3b7a2e58 8660If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
fe0503ea
NC
8661statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8662the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8663printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
4bd0bee9 8664statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
fe0503ea
NC
8665generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8666specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8667The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8668string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8669upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
a2c4f8e0 8670@end defmac
fe0503ea 8671
a2c4f8e0 8672@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
feca2ed3
JW
8673If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8674different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8675numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8676first variant.
8677
8678If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
c237e94a 8679@smallexample
f282ffb3 8680@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
c237e94a
ZW
8681@end smallexample
8682@noindent
8683in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8684first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8685@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8686@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8687within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8688alternatives within the braces than the value of
8689@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
feca2ed3
JW
8690
8691If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8692@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8693operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8694
8695Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8696@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
e5e809f4 8697the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
feca2ed3
JW
8698@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8699if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8700opcodes or operand order.
a2c4f8e0 8701@end defmac
feca2ed3 8702
a2c4f8e0 8703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8704A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8705which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8706The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8707profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8708@end defmac
feca2ed3 8709
a2c4f8e0 8710@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8711A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8712which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8713The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8714profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8715@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8716
8717@node Dispatch Tables
8718@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8719
8720@c prevent bad page break with this line
8721This concerns dispatch tables.
8722
feca2ed3 8723@cindex dispatch table
a2c4f8e0 8724@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
feca2ed3
JW
8725A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8726pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8727@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8728definitions of these labels are output using
4977bab6 8729@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
feca2ed3
JW
8730way here. For example,
8731
3ab51846 8732@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8733fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8734 @var{value}, @var{rel})
3ab51846 8735@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8736
8737You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
f0523f02 8738dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
161d7b59 8739will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
aee96fe9 8740@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
33f7f353 8741mode and flags can be read.
a2c4f8e0 8742@end defmac
feca2ed3 8743
a2c4f8e0 8744@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8745This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8746in a dispatch table are absolute.
8747
8748The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8749@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8750a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
4977bab6 8751definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
feca2ed3
JW
8752For example,
8753
3ab51846 8754@smallexample
feca2ed3 8755fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
3ab51846 8756@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 8757@end defmac
feca2ed3 8758
a2c4f8e0 8759@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8760Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8761specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
4977bab6 8762@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
feca2ed3
JW
8763jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8764@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8765
8766This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8767for the table.
8768
8769If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
4977bab6 8770@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
a2c4f8e0 8771@end defmac
feca2ed3 8772
a2c4f8e0 8773@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8774Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8775jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8776after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8777the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8778@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8779of the preceding label.
8780
8781If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8782the jump-table.
a2c4f8e0 8783@end defmac
feca2ed3 8784
914d25dc 8785@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8a36672b 8786This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
4746cf84
MA
8787should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8788should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8789function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
eeab4d81
MS
8790The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8791exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8a36672b 8792true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
4746cf84
MA
8793
8794The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8795@end deftypefn
8796
914d25dc 8797@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
083cad55
EC
8798This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8799It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8800to be broken up according to function.
8801
8802The default is that no label is emitted.
8803@end deftypefn
8804
a68b5e52
RH
8805@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8806If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8807@end deftypefn
8808
38f8b050 8809@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
914d25dc 8810This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8811given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8812returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
951120ea
PB
8813@end deftypefn
8814
3bc6b3e6
RH
8815@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8816True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8817@end deftypevr
8818
02f52e19 8819@node Exception Region Output
feca2ed3
JW
8820@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8821
8822@c prevent bad page break with this line
8823
8824This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8825region.
8826
a2c4f8e0 8827@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7c262518
RH
8828If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8829exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8830provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8831@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
0021b564
JM
8832
8833You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8834unwind information and the default definition does not work.
a2c4f8e0 8835@end defmac
0021b564 8836
a2c4f8e0 8837@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
02c9b1ca
RH
8838If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8839data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8840might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8841collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8842
8843Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8844also defined.
a2c4f8e0 8845@end defmac
02c9b1ca 8846
1a35e62d
MM
8847@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8848Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8849information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8850runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8851and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8852@end defmac
8853
a2c4f8e0 8854@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
aee96fe9 8855An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
feca2ed3 8856that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
a2c4f8e0 8857@end defmac
0021b564 8858
a2c4f8e0 8859@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
0021b564
JM
8860Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8861information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8862Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8863@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8864or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8865@end defmac
0021b564 8866
d5fabb58 8867@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
f0a0390e
RH
8868This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8869by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8870should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8871@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8872should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8873information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
0021b564 8874
f0a0390e
RH
8875A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8876This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8877default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
0021b564 8878
f0a0390e 8879Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8880not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8881@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8882setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8883macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8884depending on this setting.
8885
8886The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8887@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8888@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8889@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8890must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8891@end deftypefn
951120ea 8892
9e3be889 8893@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
617a1b71 8894This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8895tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8896command-line option processing.
9e3be889 8897@end deftypevr
617a1b71 8898
4f6c2131
EB
8899@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8900Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8901should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8902instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
c14aea87
RO
8903@end defmac
8904
a2c4f8e0 8905@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
27c35f4b
HPN
8906This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8907function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8908@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8909alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8910minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8911the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
a2c4f8e0 8912@end defmac
feca2ed3 8913
9e3be889 8914@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7606e68f
SS
8915Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8916end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8917Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8918true otherwise.
9e3be889 8919@end deftypevr
7606e68f 8920
96714395
AH
8921@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8922Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8923represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8924register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8925locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8926register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8927If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8928@end deftypefn
8929
37ea0b7e
JM
8930@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8931If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8932multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8933sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8934It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8935filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8936@var{address} is the address of the table.
8937@end deftypefn
8938
617a1b71
PB
8939@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8940This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8941the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8942if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8943reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8944@end deftypefn
8945
914d25dc
JR
8946@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8947This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
617a1b71
PB
8948based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8949the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8950running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 8951@end deftypevr
617a1b71 8952
feca2ed3
JW
8953@node Alignment Output
8954@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8955
8956@c prevent bad page break with this line
8957This describes commands for alignment.
8958
a2c4f8e0 8959@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
247a370b 8960The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
f710504c 8961a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
25e22dc0
JH
8962
8963This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8964to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8965define the macro.
efa3896a 8966
3446405d
JH
8967Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8968to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
74f7912a 8969@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
247a370b 8970selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 8971@end defmac
247a370b 8972
ad0c4c36
DD
8973@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8974The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8975@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8976@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8977@end deftypefn
8978
a2c4f8e0 8979@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
247a370b
JH
8980The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8981a @code{BARRIER}.
8982
8983This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8984to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8985define the macro.
a2c4f8e0 8986@end defmac
3446405d 8987
ad0c4c36
DD
8988@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
8989The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
efa3896a
GK
8990@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8991@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8992@end deftypefn
efa3896a 8993
a2c4f8e0 8994@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 8995The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
aee96fe9 8996a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
feca2ed3
JW
8997
8998This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8999to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9000define the macro.
9001
efa3896a 9002Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9003to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
74f7912a 9004@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9005selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9006@end defmac
efa3896a 9007
ad0c4c36
DD
9008@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9009The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9010@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9011defined.
9012@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9013
a2c4f8e0 9014@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 9015The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
aee96fe9 9016If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
fc470718
R
9017the maximum of the specified values is used.
9018
efa3896a 9019Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9020to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
74f7912a 9021@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9022selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9023@end defmac
efa3896a 9024
ad0c4c36
DD
9025@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9026The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9027to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9028is defined.
9029@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9030
a2c4f8e0 9031@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
feca2ed3
JW
9032A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9033instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9034Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
606e938d 9035expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
a2c4f8e0 9036@end defmac
feca2ed3 9037
a2c4f8e0 9038@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
feca2ed3 9039Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
556e0f21 9040text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
feca2ed3
JW
9041This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9042produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9043section.
a2c4f8e0 9044@end defmac
feca2ed3 9045
a2c4f8e0 9046@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
feca2ed3
JW
9047A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9048command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9049@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9050@end defmac
26f63a77 9051
a2c4f8e0 9052@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8e16ab99
SF
9053Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9054for padding, if necessary.
a2c4f8e0 9055@end defmac
8e16ab99 9056
a2c4f8e0 9057@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
26f63a77
JL
9058A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9059command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9060@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9061satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9062a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9063@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9064
9065@need 3000
9066@node Debugging Info
9067@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9068
9069@c prevent bad page break with this line
9070This describes how to specify debugging information.
9071
9072@menu
9073* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9074* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9075* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9076* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9077* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
5f98259a 9078* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
feca2ed3
JW
9079@end menu
9080
9081@node All Debuggers
9082@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9083
9084@c prevent bad page break with this line
9085These macros affect all debugging formats.
9086
a2c4f8e0 9087@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
feca2ed3 9088A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
4617e3b5
KG
9089register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9090of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9091some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9092versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9093compiler and another for DBX@.
feca2ed3 9094
a3a15b4d 9095If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
feca2ed3
JW
9096used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9097consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9098Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9099expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9100
9101If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9102does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9103redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
a2c4f8e0 9104@end defmac
feca2ed3 9105
a2c4f8e0 9106@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9107A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9108variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9109computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9110gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9111that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9112for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
630d3d5a 9113@option{-g} options is used.
a2c4f8e0 9114@end defmac
feca2ed3 9115
a2c4f8e0 9116@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9117A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9118having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9119@var{offset}.
a2c4f8e0 9120@end defmac
feca2ed3 9121
a2c4f8e0 9122@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
a3a15b4d 9123A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
630d3d5a 9124produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
a3a15b4d 9125this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
e5e809f4 9126debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
5f98259a
RK
9127@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9128@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
feca2ed3 9129
630d3d5a 9130When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
e5e809f4 9131value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
16201823 9132exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
e5e809f4 9133value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
a3a15b4d 9134defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
deabc777 9135
feca2ed3 9136The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
630d3d5a 9137user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
def66b10 9138@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
a2c4f8e0 9139@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9140
9141@node DBX Options
9142@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9143
9144@c prevent bad page break with this line
9145These are specific options for DBX output.
9146
a2c4f8e0 9147@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9148Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
630d3d5a 9149in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9150@end defmac
feca2ed3 9151
a2c4f8e0 9152@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9153Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
630d3d5a 9154in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
a2c4f8e0 9155@end defmac
feca2ed3 9156
a2c4f8e0 9157@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
a3a15b4d 9158Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
feca2ed3
JW
9159GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9160debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9161macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9162if there is any occasion to.
a2c4f8e0 9163@end defmac
feca2ed3 9164
a2c4f8e0 9165@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
feca2ed3
JW
9166Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9167in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 9168@end defmac
feca2ed3 9169
a2c4f8e0 9170@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9171A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9172use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9173If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9174applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9175@end defmac
feca2ed3 9176
a2c4f8e0 9177@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9178A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9179use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9180value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9181@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9182information format.
a2c4f8e0 9183@end defmac
feca2ed3 9184
a2c4f8e0 9185@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9186A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9187use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9188name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9189macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9190@end defmac
feca2ed3 9191
a2c4f8e0 9192@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
feca2ed3
JW
9193Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9194@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9195describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9196On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
a2c4f8e0 9197@end defmac
feca2ed3 9198
a2c4f8e0 9199@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
feca2ed3
JW
9200A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9201continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9202exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9203operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9204must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9205with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9206defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
a2c4f8e0 9207@end defmac
feca2ed3 9208
a2c4f8e0 9209@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
9210Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9211the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9212a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9213constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9214if backslash is correct for your system.
a2c4f8e0 9215@end defmac
feca2ed3 9216
a2c4f8e0 9217@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
feca2ed3
JW
9218Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9219outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9220variable.
a2c4f8e0 9221@end defmac
feca2ed3 9222
a2c4f8e0 9223@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9224The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9225for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9226@end defmac
feca2ed3 9227
a2c4f8e0 9228@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9229The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9230for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9231provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
a2c4f8e0 9232@end defmac
feca2ed3 9233
a2c4f8e0 9234@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9235The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9236for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9237``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9238@end defmac
feca2ed3 9239
a2c4f8e0 9240@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
feca2ed3
JW
9241The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9242passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9243do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
a2c4f8e0 9244@end defmac
feca2ed3 9245
a2c4f8e0 9246@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
feca2ed3
JW
9247Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9248arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9249in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9250code.
a2c4f8e0 9251@end defmac
feca2ed3 9252
a2c4f8e0 9253@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
3e487b21
ZW
9254Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9255the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9256relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9257an absolute address.
9258@end defmac
9259
9260@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9261Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9262the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9263start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
a2c4f8e0 9264@end defmac
feca2ed3 9265
a2c4f8e0 9266@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
f0523f02 9267Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
feca2ed3 9268@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
f0523f02
JM
9269macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9270number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
feca2ed3
JW
9271generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9272number for a type number.
a2c4f8e0 9273@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9274
9275@node DBX Hooks
9276@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9277
9278@c prevent bad page break with this line
9279These are hooks for DBX format.
9280
a2c4f8e0 9281@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
9282Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9283information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9284argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9285@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
a2c4f8e0 9286@end defmac
feca2ed3 9287
a2c4f8e0 9288@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9289Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
a2c4f8e0 9290@end defmac
feca2ed3 9291
a2c4f8e0 9292@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
374b0b7d
AM
9293Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9294output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
a2c4f8e0 9295@end defmac
374b0b7d 9296
3e487b21
ZW
9297@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9298A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9299number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8a36672b 9300@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
3e487b21
ZW
9301invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9302unique labels in the assembly output.
9303
9304This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9305if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9306@end defmac
9307
a2c4f8e0 9308@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
feca2ed3 9309Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
c771326b 9310@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
feca2ed3
JW
9311On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9312disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
a2c4f8e0 9313@end defmac
feca2ed3 9314
5d865dac
EB
9315@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9316Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9317extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9318feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9319@end defmac
9320
feca2ed3
JW
9321@node File Names and DBX
9322@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9323
9324@c prevent bad page break with this line
9325This describes file names in DBX format.
9326
a2c4f8e0 9327@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9328A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
93a27b7b 9329@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
feca2ed3
JW
9330file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9331This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9332
9333This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9334for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
93a27b7b
ZW
9335
9336It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9337text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9338to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9339@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
a2c4f8e0 9340@end defmac
feca2ed3 9341
93a27b7b
ZW
9342@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9343Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9344of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9345the beginning of the file.
9346@end defmac
feca2ed3 9347
93a27b7b
ZW
9348@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9349Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9350that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9351an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9352@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
a2c4f8e0 9353@end defmac
feca2ed3 9354
a2c4f8e0 9355@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9356A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
93a27b7b
ZW
9357compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9358written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
feca2ed3
JW
9359
9360If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9361of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
a2c4f8e0 9362@end defmac
feca2ed3 9363
3e487b21
ZW
9364@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9365Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9366@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
e4ae5e77 9367the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
3e487b21
ZW
9368whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9369@end defmac
9370
feca2ed3
JW
9371@need 2000
9372@node SDB and DWARF
9373@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9374
9375@c prevent bad page break with this line
9376Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9377
a2c4f8e0 9378@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9379Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
630d3d5a 9380for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9381@end defmac
feca2ed3 9382
a2c4f8e0 9383@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9384Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
630d3d5a 9385debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
f3ff3f4a 9386
b6fd8800 9387@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
a1c496cb
EC
9388Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9389be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9390value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9391@end deftypefn
9392
861bb6c1
JL
9393To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9394define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9395@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9396prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
08c148a8 9397as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
a2c4f8e0 9398@end defmac
861bb6c1 9399
a2c4f8e0 9400@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
a3a15b4d 9401Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9402Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9403(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9404exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9405how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 9406@end defmac
9ec36da5 9407
f0a0390e
RH
9408@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9409This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9410unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9411@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9412return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9413
9414A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9415is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9416
9417A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9418This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9419@end deftypefn
9420
a2c4f8e0 9421@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
b2244e22
JW
9422Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9423line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9424tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
a2c4f8e0 9425@end defmac
b2244e22 9426
9730bc27
TT
9427@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9428True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9429@end deftypevr
9430
a2c4f8e0 9431@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7606e68f 9432A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
192d0f89 9433@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9434@end defmac
7606e68f 9435
67ad2ae7
DR
9436@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9437A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9438between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9439slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9440@end defmac
9441
192d0f89 9442@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7606e68f 9443A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
192d0f89
GK
9444section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9445given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
a2c4f8e0 9446@end defmac
7606e68f 9447
a2c4f8e0 9448@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7606e68f 9449A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
192d0f89 9450reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9451@end defmac
7606e68f 9452
7e49a4b3
OH
9453@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9454A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9455the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9456is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9457is referenced by a function.
9458@end defmac
9459
914d25dc 9460@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
fdbe66f2
EB
9461If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9462reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9463@end deftypefn
9464
a2c4f8e0 9465@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
feca2ed3
JW
9466Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9467SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9468macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9469not define them yourself.
a2c4f8e0 9470@end defmac
feca2ed3 9471
a2c4f8e0 9472@defmac SDB_DELIM
feca2ed3
JW
9473Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9474SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9475delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9476a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9477required.
a2c4f8e0 9478@end defmac
feca2ed3 9479
a2c4f8e0 9480@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9481Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9482union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9483allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9484it.
a2c4f8e0 9485@end defmac
feca2ed3 9486
a2c4f8e0 9487@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9488Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9489enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9490assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
a2c4f8e0 9491@end defmac
feca2ed3 9492
3e487b21
ZW
9493@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9494A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9495number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9496@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9497@end defmac
9498
5f98259a
RK
9499@need 2000
9500@node VMS Debug
9501@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9502
9503@c prevent bad page break with this line
9504Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9505
a2c4f8e0 9506@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5f98259a
RK
9507Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9508in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9509is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9510@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9511behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
74f7912a 9512@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
a2c4f8e0 9513@end defmac
5f98259a 9514
b216cd4a 9515@node Floating Point
feca2ed3
JW
9516@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9517@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9518@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9519
b216cd4a 9520While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
feca2ed3
JW
9521there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9522means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9523in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9524doing the compilation.
9525
feca2ed3 9526Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
b216cd4a
ZW
9527range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9528the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9529safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9530the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9531emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9532target floating point formats are identical.
9533
9534The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9535use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
ba31d94e
ZW
9536floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9537their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
feca2ed3 9538
b216cd4a
ZW
9539@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9540The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9541machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9542array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9543quantity.
9544@end defmac
9545
9546@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9547Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9548floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9549@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9550@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9551@end deftypefn
9552
9553@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9554Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9555@end deftypefn
9556
b216cd4a
ZW
9557@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9558Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9559@end deftypefn
9560
9561@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9562Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9563@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9564@end deftypefn
9565
b216cd4a
ZW
9566@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9567Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9568representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9569decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9570defined by the C language for both.
9571@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9572
15e5ad76 9573@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
ce3649d2 9574Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
15e5ad76
ZW
9575@end deftypefn
9576
b216cd4a
ZW
9577@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9578Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9579@end deftypefn
9580
9581@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9582Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9583@end deftypefn
9584
9585@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9586Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9587@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9588variable).
9589
9590The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9591following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9592@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9593
9594If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9595target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9596@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9597@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9598@end deftypefn
9599
9600@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9601Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9602@end deftypefn
9603
15e5ad76
ZW
9604@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9605Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9606@end deftypefn
9607
b216cd4a
ZW
9608@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9609Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9610return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
ab873839 9611appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
b216cd4a
ZW
9612precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9613@end deftypefn
9614
9615@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9616Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9617which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9618integral, it is truncated.
9619@end deftypefn
9620
9621@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
b216cd4a
ZW
9622Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9623into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9624value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9625@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9626
9f09b1f2
R
9627@node Mode Switching
9628@section Mode Switching Instructions
9629@cindex mode switching
9630The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9631
a2c4f8e0 9632@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2
R
9633Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9634switching in an optimizing compilation.
9635
9636For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9637floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9638the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9639operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9640purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
e979f9e8 9641be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
18dbd950 9642or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9f09b1f2
R
9643
9644You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9645which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
14976c58 9646return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9f09b1f2
R
9647If you define this macro, you also have to define
9648@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9649@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
73774972
EC
9650@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9651are optional.
a2c4f8e0 9652@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9653
a2c4f8e0 9654@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9f09b1f2
R
9655If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9656initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9657N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9658of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
78466c0e
JM
9659The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9660zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9f09b1f2
R
9661entity in question.
9662In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
630d3d5a 9663represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9f09b1f2 9664switch is needed / supplied.
a2c4f8e0 9665@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9666
a2c4f8e0 9667@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9f09b1f2
R
9668@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9669@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9670return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
aee96fe9
JM
9671@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9672be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
a2c4f8e0 9673@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9674
73774972
EC
9675@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9676If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
8a36672b 9677mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
73774972
EC
9678different from the incoming mode).
9679@end defmac
9680
9681@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9682If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8a36672b
JM
9683mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9684@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
73774972
EC
9685is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9686@end defmac
9687
9688@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2 9689If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8a36672b
JM
9690mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9691@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
73774972 9692is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
a2c4f8e0 9693@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9694
a2c4f8e0 9695@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
aee96fe9
JM
9696This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96970 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9f09b1f2 9698lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
aee96fe9 9699for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
630d3d5a 9700(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
aee96fe9 9701@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
a2c4f8e0 9702@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9703
a2c4f8e0 9704@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9f09b1f2
R
9705Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9706@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9707the insn(s) are to be inserted.
a2c4f8e0 9708@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9709
91d231cb
JM
9710@node Target Attributes
9711@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9712@cindex target attributes
9713@cindex machine attributes
9714@cindex attributes, target-specific
9715
9716Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9717These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9718be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9719
9720@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9721If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9722attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9723specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9724entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9725take.
9726@end deftypevr
9727
564a129d
JM
9728@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9729If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9730machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9731given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9732subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9733false for all machine-specific attributes.
9734@end deftypefn
9735
b6fd8800 9736@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
91d231cb
JM
9737If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9738@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9739and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9740generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9741supposed always to be compatible.
9742@end deftypefn
9743
9744@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9745If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
914d25dc 9746the newly defined @var{type}.
91d231cb
JM
9747@end deftypefn
9748
9749@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9750Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9751handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9752@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9753that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9754function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9755merging.
9756@end deftypefn
9757
9758@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9759Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9760handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9761@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9762@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9763when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9764attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9765call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9766
9767@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
b2ca3702
MM
9768If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9769for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9770@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9771will then define a function called
9772@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9773the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9774add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9775to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9776@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9777@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
91d231cb
JM
9778@end deftypefn
9779
b6fd8800 9780@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9781@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
43d9ad1d
DS
9782@end deftypefn
9783
63c5b495 9784@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
1a141fe1 9785Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
63c5b495
MM
9786@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9787default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9788@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9789of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9790on this implementation detail.
9791@end defmac
9792
91d231cb
JM
9793@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9794Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9795when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9796wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9797the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9798created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9799for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9800shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9801the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9802attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9803needed.
9804@end deftypefn
9805
65a324b4 9806@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
91d231cb
JM
9807@cindex inlining
9808This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9809into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9810attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9811target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9812@end deftypefn
9813
914d25dc 9814@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
ab442df7
MM
9815This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9816it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9817options for the current function that might be different than the
9818options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9819@code{true} if the options are valid.
9820
9821The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9822the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9823@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9824@end deftypefn
9825
9826@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9827This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9828in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9829options.
9830@xref{Option file format}.
9831@end deftypefn
9832
9833@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9834This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9835information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9836function specific options.
9837@end deftypefn
9838
d2143a2f 9839@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
ab442df7
MM
9840This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9841information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9842function specific options.
9843@end deftypefn
9844
56cb42ea 9845@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
ab442df7
MM
9846This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9847set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9848input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9849@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
ab442df7
MM
9850@end deftypefn
9851
74f7912a
JR
9852@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9853Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9854a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9855@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9856once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9857
9858Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9859@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
74f7912a
JR
9860
9861If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9862changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9863@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9864@end deftypefn
9865
ab442df7
MM
9866@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9867This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9868cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9869default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9870specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9871@end deftypefn
9872
feb60f03
NS
9873@node Emulated TLS
9874@section Emulating TLS
9875@cindex Emulated TLS
9876
9877For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9878specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9879used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9880configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
a640c13b 9881the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
feb60f03
NS
9882layer.
9883
9884The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9885object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9886which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9887address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9888
9889@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9890Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9891object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9892emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9893@end deftypevr
9894
9895@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9896Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9897program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9898initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9899have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9900registration function to be used.
9901@end deftypevr
9902
9903@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9904Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9905be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9906any section.
9907@end deftypevr
9908
9909@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9910Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9911placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9912section.
9913@end deftypevr
9914
9915@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9916Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9917The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9918@end deftypevr
9919
9920@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9921Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9922default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9923@end deftypevr
9924
9925@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9926Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9927object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9928@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9929@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9930for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9931@end deftypefn
9932
9933@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9934Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9935TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9936is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9937initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9938@end deftypefn
9939
b6fd8800 9940@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
feb60f03
NS
9941Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9942fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9943single objects. The default is false.
9944@end deftypevr
9945
b6fd8800 9946@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
feb60f03
NS
9947Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9948may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9949@end deftypevr
9950
d604bca3
MH
9951@node MIPS Coprocessors
9952@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9953@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9954
9955The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
2dd76960 9956coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
d604bca3
MH
9957accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9958and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9959
9960@smallexample
9961 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9962 unsigned int d;
9963
9964 d = cp0count + 3;
9965@end smallexample
9966
9967(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9968names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9969overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9970
9971Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9972be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9973later in the function.
9974
9975Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8a36672b 9976the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
d604bca3
MH
9977floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9978
9979There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9980you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9981
a2c4f8e0 9982@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
d604bca3
MH
9983A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9984alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9985@smallexample
9986@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9987@end smallexample
9988Default: empty.
a2c4f8e0 9989@end defmac
d604bca3 9990
7bb1ad93
GK
9991@node PCH Target
9992@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9993@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9994
0678ade0 9995@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
914d25dc
JR
9996This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9997@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
0678ade0 9998@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7bb1ad93
GK
9999@end deftypefn
10000
b6fd8800 10001@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8d932be3
RS
10002This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10003compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10004if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10005be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10006
10007@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10008when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10009It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10010compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10011
10012The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10013suitable for most targets.
10014@end deftypefn
10015
b6fd8800 10016@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8d932be3
RS
10017If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10018@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10019of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10020@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10021value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7bb1ad93
GK
10022@end deftypefn
10023
4185ae53
PB
10024@node C++ ABI
10025@section C++ ABI parameters
10026@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10027
10028@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10029Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10030These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10031default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10032@end deftypefn
10033
10034@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
f676971a 10035This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
914d25dc
JR
10036@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10037@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
4185ae53
PB
10038@end deftypefn
10039
46e995e0
PB
10040@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10041This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10042whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10043known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10044@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8a36672b 10045IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
46e995e0
PB
10046@end deftypefn
10047
10048@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10049This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10050array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10051@end deftypefn
10052
38f8b050 10053@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
d59c7b4b
NC
10054If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10055class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
78466c0e 10056will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
d59c7b4b
NC
10057to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10058modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10059backend's targeted operating system.
10060@end deftypefn
10061
44d10c10
PB
10062@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10063This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10064the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10065@code{false}.
10066@end deftypefn
10067
af287697
MM
10068@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10069This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10070which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10071table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10072Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10073the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10074some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10075method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10076@end deftypefn
10077
1e731102 10078@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 10079@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
1e731102
MM
10080@end deftypefn
10081
10082@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10083This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10084similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10085external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10086classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10087unit will not be COMDAT.
505970fc
MM
10088@end deftypefn
10089
157600d0
GK
10090@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10091This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10092the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10093be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10094@end deftypefn
10095
9f62c3e3
PB
10096@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10097This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10098should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10099is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10100@end deftypefn
10101
97388150
DS
10102@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10103This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10104in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10105destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10106shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10107unloaded. The default is to return false.
10108@end deftypefn
10109
43d9ad1d 10110@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
38f8b050 10111@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
43d9ad1d
DS
10112@end deftypefn
10113
09e881c9
BE
10114@node Named Address Spaces
10115@section Adding support for named address spaces
10116@cindex named address spaces
10117
10118The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10119standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10120support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10121processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10122GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10123address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10124spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10125@code{const} type attributes.
10126
02a9370c 10127Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
09e881c9
BE
10128pointers to the generic address space.
10129
10130For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10131to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10132processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10133issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10134local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10135address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10136@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10137always 32 bits).
10138
10139Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10140range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10141address space.
10142
3ef0694c
UW
10143To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10144the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10145the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10146named address space #1:
36c5e70a
BE
10147@smallexample
10148#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
3ef0694c 10149c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
36c5e70a 10150@end smallexample
36c5e70a 10151
d4ebfa65
BE
10152@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10153Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10154@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10155The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10156generic address space only.
10157@end deftypefn
10158
10159@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10160Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10161@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10162The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10163generic address space only.
10164@end deftypefn
10165
10166@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10167Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10168with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10169hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10170except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10171version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10172@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10173target hooks for the given address space.
10174@end deftypefn
10175
b6fd8800 10176@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10177Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10178@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10179parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10180finished. This target hook is the same as the
10181@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10182explicit named address space support.
10183@end deftypefn
10184
b6fd8800 10185@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10186Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10187with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10188hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10189except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10190@end deftypefn
10191
b6fd8800 10192@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{superset}, addr_space_t @var{subset})
09e881c9
BE
10193Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10194contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10195a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10196will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10197arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
a4ce9883 10198converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
09e881c9
BE
10199@end deftypefn
10200
b6fd8800 10201@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
09e881c9
BE
10202Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10203@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10204space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10205to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10206guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10207as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10208@end deftypefn
10209
feca2ed3
JW
10210@node Misc
10211@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10212@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10213
10214@c prevent bad page break with this line
10215Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10216
e543e219
ZW
10217@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10218Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10219has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10220conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10221blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10222set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10223to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10224@end defmac
10225
10226@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10227Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10228has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10229conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10230blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10231set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10232to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
a2c4f8e0 10233@end defmac
8fe0ca0c 10234
a2c4f8e0 10235@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
feca2ed3
JW
10236An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10237elements of a jump-table should have.
a2c4f8e0 10238@end defmac
feca2ed3 10239
a2c4f8e0 10240@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
33f7f353
JR
10241Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10242when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10243it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
4226378a 10244To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
33f7f353 10245make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
391aaa6b 10246The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
33f7f353 10247flags can be updated.
a2c4f8e0 10248@end defmac
33f7f353 10249
a2c4f8e0 10250@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
18543a22 10251Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9c49953c
KH
10252should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10253jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10254contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10255is in effect.
a2c4f8e0 10256@end defmac
feca2ed3 10257
b6fd8800 10258@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
e6ff3083 10259This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
feca2ed3
JW
10260is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10261The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10262five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
e6ff3083 10263@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 10264
a2c4f8e0 10265@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
9bb231fd
RS
10266Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10267statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10268advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10269of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10270targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10271@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10272@code{false} otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 10273@end defmac
9bb231fd 10274
a2c4f8e0 10275@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
feca2ed3
JW
10276Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10277smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10278Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
a2c4f8e0 10279@end defmac
feca2ed3 10280
7be4d808 10281@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
feca2ed3 10282Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7be4d808
R
10283memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10284bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
feca2ed3 10285zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7be4d808 10286of @var{mem_mode} for which the
feca2ed3 10287insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
f822d252 10288@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
feca2ed3 10289
7be4d808 10290This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
feca2ed3
JW
10291greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10292value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
f822d252 10293@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
feca2ed3 10294define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7be4d808 10295
f822d252 10296You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7be4d808
R
10297the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10298of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10299when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10300integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10301
f822d252 10302You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7be4d808
R
10303mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10304@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10305is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
a2c4f8e0 10306@end defmac
feca2ed3 10307
a2c4f8e0 10308@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
77643ab8
MM
10309Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10310extends.
a2c4f8e0 10311@end defmac
77643ab8 10312
a2c4f8e0 10313@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
feca2ed3
JW
10314Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10315point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10316unsigned one.
a2c4f8e0 10317@end defmac
feca2ed3 10318
728d406c 10319@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
bc23502b
PB
10320When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10321divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10322the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10323that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10324of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10325has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10326@end deftypefn
10327
a2c4f8e0 10328@defmac MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10329The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10330between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
a2c4f8e0 10331@end defmac
feca2ed3 10332
a2c4f8e0 10333@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10334The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10335between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10336is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10337constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10338at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 10339@end defmac
feca2ed3 10340
a2c4f8e0 10341@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
feca2ed3
JW
10342A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10343actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10344of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
df2a54e9 10345this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
feca2ed3
JW
10346a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10347truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
c771326b 10348instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
feca2ed3
JW
10349include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10350also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
c771326b 10351arguments to bit-field instructions.
feca2ed3
JW
10352
10353If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
c771326b 10354position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
feca2ed3
JW
10355instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10356
10357However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10358only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
c771326b 10359bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
feca2ed3
JW
10360such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10361the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10362
10363You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
a2c4f8e0 10364@end defmac
feca2ed3 10365
273a2526 10366@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
914d25dc 10367@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
273a2526
RS
10368This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10369deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10370@xref{shift patterns}.
10371
10372On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10373shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10374equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10375this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10376otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10377particular behavior is guaranteed.
10378
10379Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10380@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10381that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10382
10383The default implementation of this function returns
10384@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10385and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10386@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10387nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10388by overriding it.
10389@end deftypefn
10390
a2c4f8e0 10391@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
feca2ed3
JW
10392A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10393``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10394bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10395operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10396
10397On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10398
10399@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10400@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10401When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10402modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10403If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10404such cases may improve things.
a2c4f8e0 10405@end defmac
feca2ed3 10406
b12cbf2c 10407@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
66a4ad37 10408The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
b12cbf2c
AN
10409are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10410@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10411sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10412otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10413representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10414@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10415@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
914d25dc 10416@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
b12cbf2c
AN
10417widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10418
10419Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10420value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10421as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10422@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10423
10424Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10425describe two related properties. If you define
10426@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10427to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10428extension.
10429
10430In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10431@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10432@code{mode}.
10433@end deftypefn
10434
a2c4f8e0 10435@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
feca2ed3
JW
10436A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10437with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
ac5eda13
PB
10438(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10439apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
feca2ed3
JW
10440comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10441
630d3d5a
JM
10442A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10443comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
feca2ed3
JW
10444and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10445which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10446true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10447operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
ac5eda13 10448@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
feca2ed3
JW
10449@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10450the compiler.
10451
630d3d5a 10452If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
feca2ed3
JW
10453generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10454replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10455the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10456For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10457@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10458@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10459expression
10460
10461@smallexample
10462(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10463@end smallexample
10464
10465@noindent
10466can be converted to
10467
10468@smallexample
10469(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10470@end smallexample
10471
10472@noindent
10473where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10474tested into the sign bit.
10475
10476There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10477for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10478but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
a3a15b4d 10479are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
feca2ed3 10480perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
b11cc610 10481comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
feca2ed3
JW
10482
10483Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10484from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10485choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10486to be used:
10487
10488@itemize @bullet
10489@item
10490Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10491@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10492``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10493comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10494combine the normalization with other operations.
10495
10496@item
630d3d5a 10497For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
feca2ed3
JW
10498slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10499other machines.
10500
10501@item
10502As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10503exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10504others.
10505
10506@item
10507Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10508@end itemize
10509
10510Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10511@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10512instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10513those cases, e.g., one matching
10514
10515@smallexample
10516(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10517@end smallexample
10518
10519Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10520condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
ac5eda13 10521@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
feca2ed3
JW
10522machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10523and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10524@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10525@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10526find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10527
06f31100
RS
10528If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10529not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10530instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
a2c4f8e0 10531@end defmac
feca2ed3 10532
a2c4f8e0 10533@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
df2a54e9 10534A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
feca2ed3 10535returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
fc7ca5fd 10536Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
feca2ed3
JW
10537floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10538this macro.
a2c4f8e0 10539@end defmac
feca2ed3 10540
fc7ca5fd 10541@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
a4d05547 10542A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
fc7ca5fd
RS
10543for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10544mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10545this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10546return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10547this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10548@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10549the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10550given mode.
10551@end defmac
10552
a2c4f8e0
ZW
10553@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10554@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
14670a74
SL
10555A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10556for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10557A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10558If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10559evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10560entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10561the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10562In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10563this value.
10564
10565If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10566@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7dba8395
RH
10567
10568This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10569relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
14670a74
SL
10570is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10571to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7dba8395
RH
10572
10573Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10574and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10575visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10576to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8a36672b 10577breaking the API@.
a2c4f8e0 10578@end defmac
7dba8395 10579
a2c4f8e0 10580@defmac Pmode
feca2ed3
JW
10581An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10582this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10583pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10584On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10585modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10586
10587The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10588@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10589@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10590to @code{Pmode}.
a2c4f8e0 10591@end defmac
feca2ed3 10592
a2c4f8e0 10593@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
feca2ed3 10594An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
f71e957e
DK
10595being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10596where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10597@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10598size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10599as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
a2c4f8e0 10600@end defmac
feca2ed3 10601
a2c4f8e0 10602@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
ee773fcc
NB
10603In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10604constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10605hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10606where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10607strict conformance to the C Standard.
10608
10609Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10610convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10611files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
a2c4f8e0 10612@end defmac
ee773fcc 10613
a2c4f8e0 10614@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
161d7b59 10615Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
feca2ed3
JW
10616This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10617C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10618@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
a2c4f8e0 10619@end defmac
feca2ed3 10620
feca2ed3
JW
10621@findex #pragma
10622@findex pragma
a2c4f8e0 10623@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8b97c5f8 10624Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
a5da89c6 10625If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
b5b3e36a
DJ
10626@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10627for each pragma. The macro may also do any
a5da89c6 10628setup required for the pragmas.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10629
10630The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10631other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
161d7b59 10632definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
feca2ed3 10633
c237e94a 10634If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
91d231cb 10635defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
f09db6e0 10636
8b97c5f8
ZW
10637Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10638@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
630d3d5a 10639silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
a2c4f8e0 10640@end defmac
8b97c5f8 10641
c58b209a 10642@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
b5b3e36a 10643@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8b97c5f8 10644
b5b3e36a
DJ
10645Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10646@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8b97c5f8
ZW
10647@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10648pragma of the form
10649
10650@smallexample
10651#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10652@end smallexample
10653
a5da89c6
NB
10654@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10655@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10656routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
51fabca5 10657on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
75ce3d48 10658@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
51fabca5 10659callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
b5b3e36a
DJ
10660a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10661arguments of pragmas registered with
10662@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10663pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8b97c5f8 10664
75ce3d48 10665Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
aac69a49 10666compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
75ce3d48 10667other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
aac69a49 10668to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
c771326b 10669building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
aac69a49 10670variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
aee96fe9 10671target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
aac69a49 10672the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
75ce3d48 10673code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
aac69a49
NC
10674rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10675how to build this object file.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10676@end deftypefun
10677
b5b3e36a 10678@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10679Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
b5b3e36a
DJ
10680arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10681@end defmac
10682
914d25dc
JR
10683@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10684True if @code{#pragma extern_prefix} is to be supported.
10685@end deftypevr
10686
467cecf3
JB
10687@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10688If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
0bdcd332 10689the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8b7d4300 10690This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
467cecf3
JB
10691@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10692@end defmac
10693
a2c4f8e0 10694@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
b1822ccc 10695Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
170ea7b9 10696identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
b1822ccc
NB
10697not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10698there is no need to define this macro in that case.
a2c4f8e0 10699@end defmac
feca2ed3 10700
a2c4f8e0 10701@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
feca2ed3
JW
10702Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10703@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10704G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10705@samp{.} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 10706@end defmac
feca2ed3 10707
a2c4f8e0 10708@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
feca2ed3
JW
10709Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10710@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10711have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10712are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
a2c4f8e0 10713@end defmac
feca2ed3 10714
a2c4f8e0 10715@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10716Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10717delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10718even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
a3a15b4d 10719@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
feca2ed3
JW
10720every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10721or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10722you should define this macro.
10723
10724You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10725@end defmac
feca2ed3 10726
a2c4f8e0 10727@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10728Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10729delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10730even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10731@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10732some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10733are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10734define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10735instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10736slot of @var{insn}.
10737
10738You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10739@end defmac
feca2ed3 10740
a2c4f8e0 10741@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
15072eb1
ZW
10742Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10743global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10744symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10745instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10746from shared libraries (DLLs).
10747
10748You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
a2c4f8e0 10749@end defmac
861bb6c1 10750
61158923 10751@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
67dfe110 10752This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
61158923 10753any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
67dfe110 10754It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
61158923
HPN
10755clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10756corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10757clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
91b4415a 10758@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
61158923 10759for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
67dfe110 10760@end deftypefn
57bcb97a 10761
a2c4f8e0 10762@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
71d718e0 10763Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10764in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10765@samp{""} if the target does not have a
71d718e0
JM
10766separate math library.
10767
d9d16a19 10768You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10769@end defmac
512b62fb 10770
a2c4f8e0 10771@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
512b62fb
JM
10772Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10773specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10774
10775You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10776is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10777@end defmac
e09d24ff 10778
4969c0d8
L
10779@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10780Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10781functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10782Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
e09d24ff 10783to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
4969c0d8 10784if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
709a840a 10785for cross-profiling.
a2c4f8e0 10786@end defmac
0c99ec5c 10787
a2c4f8e0 10788@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
0c99ec5c
RH
10789
10790A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10791conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10792@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107931 if it does use cc0.
a2c4f8e0 10794@end defmac
90280148 10795
a2c4f8e0 10796@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10797Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10798conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10799@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10800contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10801and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10802then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10803@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
a2c4f8e0 10804@end defmac
c05ffc49 10805
a2c4f8e0 10806@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10807Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10808if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10809@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10810being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
a2c4f8e0 10811@end defmac
90280148 10812
a2c4f8e0 10813@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
c05ffc49
BS
10814A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10815be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10816a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10817about the currently processed blocks.
a2c4f8e0 10818@end defmac
90280148 10819
a2c4f8e0 10820@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10821A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10822converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10823can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10824to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10825@end defmac
90280148 10826
a2c4f8e0 10827@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10828A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10829converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10830can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10831to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10832@end defmac
c05ffc49 10833
a2c4f8e0 10834@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
c05ffc49
BS
10835A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10836structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
a2c4f8e0 10837@end defmac
c05ffc49 10838
a2c4f8e0 10839@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
c05ffc49 10840If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
c0478a66 10841added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
c05ffc49 10842by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
a2c4f8e0 10843@end defmac
c05ffc49 10844
b6fd8800 10845@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
18dbd950
RS
10846If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10847instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10848just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10849
10850The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10851it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10852laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10853Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10854
10855You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10856definition is null.
10857@end deftypefn
10858
b6fd8800 10859@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
f6155fda
SS
10860Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10861that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
4a1d48f6
BS
10862necessary setup.
10863
c771326b 10864Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
4a1d48f6
BS
10865instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10866they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10867instructions or prefetch instructions).
10868
6e34d3a3
JM
10869To create a built-in function, call the function
10870@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
c771326b 10871which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
4a1d48f6 10872up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
c237e94a 10873only language front ends that use those two functions will call
f6155fda 10874@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
acdcefcc 10875@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10876
914d25dc 10877@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
e9e4b3a8
RG
10878Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10879that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10880builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10881If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10882if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10883If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10884@code{error_mark_node}.
10885@end deftypefn
10886
f6155fda 10887@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
4a1d48f6 10888
c771326b 10889Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
f6155fda
SS
10890@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10891function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10892convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10893@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10894@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10895ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10896built-in function.
acdcefcc 10897@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10898
7a241624 10899@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
4268e4cf
PB
10900Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10901was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10902@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10903implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10904declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10905arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10906complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10907another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
7a241624 10908@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
4268e4cf
PB
10909@end deftypefn
10910
f311c3b4 10911@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
a05a80fc
KH
10912Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10913@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
f311c3b4
NF
10914built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10915the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10916The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10917call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
d6c2b67d
PB
10918@end deftypefn
10919
72392b81 10920@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
a71a498d 10921
e7e64a25 10922Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
72392b81
JR
10923low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10924could not be applied.
a71a498d 10925
e7e64a25
AS
10926Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10927instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
083cad55 10928the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
a71a498d 10929By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
083cad55 10930loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
a71a498d
AS
10931@end deftypefn
10932
a2c4f8e0 10933@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
6e7b03e1 10934
4fe9b91c 10935Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
6e7b03e1
AH
10936Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10937@var{branch2} is possible.
10938
10939On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10940filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10941may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
a2c4f8e0 10942@end defmac
6e7b03e1 10943
914d25dc 10944@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
8ddf681a
R
10945This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10946Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
0ee2ea09 10947PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
8ddf681a
R
10948of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10949@end deftypefn
10950
b48f503c 10951@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
385b6e2d
R
10952
10953When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
4fe9b91c 10954register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
385b6e2d 10955to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
b48f503c
KK
10956it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10957is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10958that had its initial value copied by using
385b6e2d
R
10959@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10960Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10961to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10962the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10963@code{MEM}.
10964If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10965it might decide to use another register anyways.
b48f503c
KK
10966You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10967that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
385b6e2d 10968register in question will not be clobbered.
b48f503c
KK
10969The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10970allocation.
10971@end deftypefn
385b6e2d 10972
215b063c
PB
10973@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
10974This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10975@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10976this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10977@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10978to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10979passed along.
10980@end deftypefn
10981
db2960f4
SL
10982@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
10983The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10984context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10985the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10986per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10987attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10988The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10989and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10990and is returning to processing at the top level.
10991The default hook function does nothing.
10992
10993GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10994some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10995situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10996or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
914d25dc
JR
10997@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10998outside of any function scope.
db2960f4
SL
10999@end deftypefn
11000
a2c4f8e0 11001@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11002Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11003files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11004use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
a2c4f8e0 11005@end defmac
807633e5 11006
a2c4f8e0 11007@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11008Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11009automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11010do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11011executable files.
a2c4f8e0 11012@end defmac
807633e5 11013
a2c4f8e0 11014@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
807633e5
ZW
11015If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11016specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11017Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11018object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11019lists.
a2c4f8e0 11020@end defmac
807633e5 11021
a2c4f8e0 11022@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
55ae46b1
RM
11023Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11024method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11025must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
95fef11f 11026For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
55ae46b1
RM
11027the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11028defined as this expression:
11029
11030@smallexample
11031build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11032 build_tree_list
11033 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11034 NULL))
11035@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 11036@end defmac
e4ec2cac
AO
11037
11038@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11039This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11040instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11041every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11042reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11043
11044@smallexample
11045static bool
11046cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11047@{
11048 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11049@}
11050@end smallexample
11051@end deftypefn
fe3ad572 11052
a87cf97e 11053@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
fe3ad572
SC
11054This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11055optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c0cbdbd9 11056usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
fe3ad572
SC
11057re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11058to inter-block scheduling.
11059@end deftypefn
11060
11061@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11062Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11063registers
11064that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11065returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11066that all target registers in the class returned by
11067@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11068saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11069epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11070true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11071to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11072to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11073@end deftypefn
2082e02f 11074
2929029c
WG
11075@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11076This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11077This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11078modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11079@end deftypefn
11080
40ac4f73
CB
11081@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11082This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11083should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11084the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11085the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11086is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11087number of memory accesses.
11088@end deftypefn
11089
2082e02f 11090@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
73774972 11091If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
2082e02f
RS
11092that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11093that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11094constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11095more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11096system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11097The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11098@end defmac
94d1613b 11099
3dd53121 11100@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
94d1613b
MS
11101This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11102target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
3dd53121
AP
11103are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11104The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11105@end deftypefn
11106
11107@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11108This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11109target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11110indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11111@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11112@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
94d1613b
MS
11113@end deftypefn
11114
11115@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11116This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11117The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11118systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11119that are different from @option{-I}.
11120@end deftypefn
4a77e08c 11121
914d25dc
JR
11122@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11123This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
4a77e08c 11124for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
914d25dc 11125@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
431ae0bf 11126functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
4a77e08c 11127@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
914d25dc 11128@end defmac
a2bec818
DJ
11129
11130@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11131If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11132target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11133option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11134@end defmac
11135
11136@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11137If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11138@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11139@end defmac
e50e6b88 11140
6590fc9f
KT
11141@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11142If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11143target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11144default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11145@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11146@end defmac
11147
11148@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11149If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11150@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11151@end defmac
11152
94564826
KT
11153@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11154If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11155routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11156and scanf formatter settings.
11157@end defmac
11158
914d25dc 11159@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
445cf5eb
JM
11160If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11161guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11162main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11163important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11164many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11165``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11166and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 11167@end deftypevr
445cf5eb 11168
b6fd8800 11169@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
083cad55
EC
11170If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11171illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
4d3e6fae
FJ
11172with prototype @var{typelist}.
11173@end deftypefn
11174
b6fd8800 11175@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
4de67c26
JM
11176If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11177invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11178if validity should be determined by the front end.
11179@end deftypefn
11180
b6fd8800 11181@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
4de67c26
JM
11182If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11183invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11184@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11185if validity should be determined by the front end.
11186@end deftypefn
11187
b6fd8800 11188@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4de67c26
JM
11189If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11190invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11191and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11192the front end.
11193@end deftypefn
11194
b6fd8800 11195@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90
SL
11196If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11197invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11198or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11199the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11200@end deftypefn
11201
b6fd8800 11202@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90
SL
11203If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11204invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11205or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11206the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11207@end deftypefn
11208
b6fd8800 11209@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90
SL
11210If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11211@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11212analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11213front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11214target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11215This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11216@end deftypefn
11217
b6fd8800 11218@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
40449a90
SL
11219If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11220@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11221or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11222This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11223conversion rules.
11224This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11225@end deftypefn
11226
e50e6b88
DS
11227@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11228This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11229classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11230SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11231@end defmac
64ee9490
EC
11232
11233@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11234This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11235NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11236@end defmac
56e449d3
SL
11237
11238@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11239Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11240to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11241call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11242and the associated definitions of those functions.
11243@end defmac
007e61c2 11244
2e3f842f
L
11245@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11246Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11247necessary.
11248@end deftypefn
11249
11250@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
914d25dc 11251This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
2e3f842f 11252different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
914d25dc
JR
11253argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11254is needed.
2e3f842f
L
11255@end deftypefn
11256
b6fd8800 11257@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
007e61c2
PB
11258When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11259arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11260stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11261debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11262@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11263cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11264to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11265false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11266@end deftypefn
2c5bfdf7 11267
2c5bfdf7
AN
11268@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11269On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11270a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11271is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11272is computed from this register using immediate addition or
a4ce9883 11273subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
2c5bfdf7
AN
11274the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11275available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11276constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11277down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11278@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11279accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11280value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11281MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11282@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11283is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr